blob: aa4826fc2d13f1edf08ce9942606a25f451c1c82 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4c47d912020-02-07 04:12:19 +01007 2020/02/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - presetenv
615 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - uid
617 - ulimit-n
618 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200619 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100620 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200621 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-options
625 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-options
628 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200672 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200673 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200674 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100675 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200676 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200677 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100678 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100680 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.session-timeout
682 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200683 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100684 - tune.maxaccept
685 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200686 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200687 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200688 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100689 - tune.rcvbuf.client
690 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100691 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200692 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.sndbuf.client
694 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100695 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200697 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100698 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200699 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200700 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100701 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100703 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200704 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
705 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
706 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100707 - tune.zlib.memlevel
708 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 * Debugging
711 - debug
712 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713
714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716------------------------------------
717
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200718ca-base <dir>
719 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200720 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
721 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723chroot <jail dir>
724 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
725 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
726 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
727 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
728 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100730
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
732 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
733 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
734 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
735 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
736 set. These sets have the format
737
738 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
739
740 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
743 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100744 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
745 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100747 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
751 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
752 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
753 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100754
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100755 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
756 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
757 on the machine's word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
761 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
762 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
763 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
764 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
765 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766
767 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
769
770 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
771 # first 4 CPUs
772
773 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
774 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
775 # word size.
776
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
784 # and so on.
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100789 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
791 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
792 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
793
794 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
795 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
797
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100798 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
799 # and a thread range.
800 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
803
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200804crt-base <dir>
805 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100806 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
807 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809daemon
810 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
811 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100812 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
813 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815deviceatlas-json-file <path>
816 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100817 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200818
819deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100820 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
822
823deviceatlas-separator <char>
824 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
825 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
826
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100827deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200828 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
829 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
830 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100831
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900832external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100833 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
834 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100835 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
836 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
837 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
838 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
839 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841gid <number>
842 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
843 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
844 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100845 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
846 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100848
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100849group <group name>
850 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
851 See also "gid" and "user".
852
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100853hard-stop-after <time>
854 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
855
856 Arguments :
857 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
858 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
859 SIGUSR1 signal.
860
861 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
862 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
863 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
864
865 Example:
866 global
867 hard-stop-after 30s
868
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200869h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
870 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
871 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
872 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
873 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
874 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
875 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
876 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
877 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
878 specified in a proxy.
879
880 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
881 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
882 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
883 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
884 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
885 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
886 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
887
888 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
889 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
890 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
891 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
892 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
893
894 Example:
895 global
896 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
897
898 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
899 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
900
901h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
902 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
903 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
904 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
905 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
906 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
907 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
908 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
909 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
910
911 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
912 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
913 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
914
915 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
916 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
917
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100918insecure-fork-wanted
919 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
920 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
921 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
922 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
923 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
924 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
925 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
926 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
927 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
928 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
929 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
930 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
931 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
932 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
933 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
934 disable it.
935
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100936insecure-setuid-wanted
937 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
938 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
939 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
940 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
941 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
942 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
943 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
944 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
945 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
946 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
947 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
948 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
949 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
950 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
951
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
953 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100954 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100955 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100956 configured with "log global".
957
958 <address> can be one of:
959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100960 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100961 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
962 port).
963
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100964 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
965 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
966 port).
967
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100968 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100969 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
970 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100972
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100973 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
974 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
975 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
976 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
977 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
978 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
979 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
980 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
981 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
982 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
983 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
984 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
985 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
986 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100987 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
988 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100989
990 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
991 "fd@2", see above.
992
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200993 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
994 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
995 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
996 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
997 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
998
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1000 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001001
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001002 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1003 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1004 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1005 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1006 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1007 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1008 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1009 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1010 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1011 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001012 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1013 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001014
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001015 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1016 one of the following :
1017
1018 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1019 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1020
1021 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1022 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1023
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001024 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1025 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1026 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1027 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1028 logger consumes.
1029
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001030 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1031 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1032 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1033 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1034
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001035 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1036 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1037 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1038 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1039 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1040
1041 <sample_size>
1042 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1043 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1044 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1045 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1046 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1047
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001048 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001050 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1051 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1052 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1053
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001054 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1055 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1056 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1057 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058
1059 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001060 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1061 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1062 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1063 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1064 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1065 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001067 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001069log-send-hostname [<string>]
1070 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1071 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1072 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1073 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1074 the logs.
1075
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001076log-tag <string>
1077 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1078 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1079 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001080 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082lua-load <file>
1083 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1084 used multiple times.
1085
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001086lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1087 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1088 variable.
1089 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1090 to "path".
1091
1092 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1093 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1094 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1095 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1096 will be checked earlier.
1097
1098 As an example by specifying the following path:
1099
1100 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1101 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1102
1103 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1104 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1105 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1106 paths if that does not exist either.
1107
1108 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1109 documentation.
1110
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001111master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001112 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1113 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1114 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001115 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001116 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1117 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001118 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1119 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1120 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1121 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1122 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001123
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001124 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001125
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001126mworker-max-reloads <number>
1127 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001128 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001129 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1130 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1131 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133nbproc <number>
1134 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1135 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1136 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001137 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1138 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001139 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1140 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001142nbthread <number>
1143 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001144 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1145 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1146 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1147 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1148 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001149 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1150 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1151 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1152 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1153 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1154 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1155 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001156
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1160 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162presetenv <name> <value>
1163 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1164 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1165 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1166 and "unsetenv".
1167
1168resetenv [<name> ...]
1169 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1170 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1171 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1172 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1173 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1174 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1175 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1176 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1177
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001178stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001179 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1180 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1181 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1182 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1183 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1184 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001185 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001186 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1187 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1188 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1189 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001190
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001191server-state-base <directory>
1192 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001193 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1194 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001195
1196server-state-file <file>
1197 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1198 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1199 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1200 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1201 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1202 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1203 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1204 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001205 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1206 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001207
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001208setenv <name> <value>
1209 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1210 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1211 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1212 and "unsetenv".
1213
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001214set-dumpable
1215 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001216 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1217 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1218 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1219 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1220 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1221 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1222 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1223 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1224 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1225 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1226 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1227 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1228 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1229 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1230 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1231 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1232 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001234ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1236 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001237 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001238 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001239 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1240 information and recommendations see e.g.
1241 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1242 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1243 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1244 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001245
1246ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1248 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1249 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1250 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1251 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001252 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1253 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1254 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001255 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001256
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001257ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1259 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1260 keyword to see available options.
1261
1262 Example:
1263 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001264 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001265
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001266ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1268 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001269 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001270 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1272 information and recommendations see e.g.
1273 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1274 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1275 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1276 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1277 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1282 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1283 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1284 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1288 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1293 keyword to see available options.
1294
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1298 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001299 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001300 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001301 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1302 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1303 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1304 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001305 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1306 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1307 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1308
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001309ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer>*
1310 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1311 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1312
1313 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1314 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1315 optimize the startup time.
1316
1317 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1318 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1319 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1320
1321 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
1322 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer.
1323
1324 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1325 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1326 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1327 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1328 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1329 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
1330 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specifiy both the ECDSA
1331 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1332
1333 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1334
1335 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1336
1337 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1338 not provided in the PEM file.
1339
1340 The default behavior is "all".
1341
1342 Example:
1343 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1344 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1345 ssl-load-extra-files none
1346
1347 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1348
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001349ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1350 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1351 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1352 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1353
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001354stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1355 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1356 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1357 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001358 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001359 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001360
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001361 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1362 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1363 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001364
1365stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1366 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1367 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001368 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001369
1370stats maxconn <connections>
1371 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1372 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1373
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001374uid <number>
1375 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1376 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1377 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1378 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1379
1380ulimit-n <number>
1381 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1382 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1383 option.
1384
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001385unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1386 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1387
1388 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1389 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1390 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1391 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1392 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1393 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1394 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1395 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1396 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1397 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1398
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001399unsetenv [<name> ...]
1400 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1401 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1402 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1403 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1404 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1405 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1406 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1407
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001408user <user name>
1409 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1410 See also "uid" and "group".
1411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001412node <name>
1413 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1414
1415 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1416 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1417 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1418 traffic.
1419
1420description <text>
1421 Add a text that describes the instance.
1422
1423 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1424 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1425 "<" and ">" characters.
1426
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100142751degrees-data-file <file path>
1428 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001429 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001430
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001431 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001432 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1433
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000143451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001435 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1436 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1437 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1438
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001439 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001440 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1441
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200144251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001443 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1444 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1445
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1447 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1448
144951degrees-cache-size <number>
1450 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1451 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1452 By default, this cache is disabled.
1453
1454 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001455 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1456
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001457wurfl-data-file <file path>
1458 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1459 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1460
1461 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1462 with USE_WURFL=1.
1463
1464wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1465 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1466 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1467 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1468
1469 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1470
1471 Valid WURFL properties are:
1472 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1473
1474 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1475 device.
1476
1477 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1478 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1479
1480 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1481 particular web request.
1482
1483 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1484 used Libwurfl API version.
1485
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001486 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1487 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1488
1489 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1490 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1491
1492 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1493
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1495 with USE_WURFL=1.
1496
1497wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1498 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1499 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1500
1501 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1502 with USE_WURFL=1.
1503
1504wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1505 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1506 thus before the chroot.
1507
1508 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1509 with USE_WURFL=1.
1510
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001511wurfl-cache-size <size>
1512 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1513 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001514 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001515 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1518 with USE_WURFL=1.
1519
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001520strict-limits
1521 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1522 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1523 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1524 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1525 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1526 keyword.
1527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015283.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529-----------------------
1530
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001531busy-polling
1532 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1533 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1534 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1535 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1536 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1537 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1538 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1539 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1540 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1541 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1542 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1543 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1544 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1545 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1546 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1547 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1548 "poll" pollers.
1549
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001550 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1551 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1552 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1553
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001554max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1555 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1556 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1557 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1558 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1559 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1560 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1561 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1562 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001564maxconn <number>
1565 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1566 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1567 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001568 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1569 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1570 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1571 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001572 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1573 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1574 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1575 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1576 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1577 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001579maxconnrate <number>
1580 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1581 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1582 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1583 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1584 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1585 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1586 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1587 fairness.
1588
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001589maxcomprate <number>
1590 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001591 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001592 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1593 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1594 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001596 default value.
1597
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001598maxcompcpuusage <number>
1599 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1600 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1601 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1602 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1603 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1604 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1605 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1606 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1607
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001608maxpipes <number>
1609 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1610 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1611 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1612 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1613 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1614 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1615
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001616maxsessrate <number>
1617 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1618 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1619 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1620 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1621 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1622 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1623 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1624 fairness.
1625
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001626maxsslconn <number>
1627 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1628 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1629 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1630 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1631 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1632 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1633 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001634 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1635 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1636 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1637 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1638 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1639 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1640 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001641
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001642maxsslrate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1644 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1645 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1646 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1647 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1648 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1649 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1650 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1651 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1652 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1653
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001654maxzlibmem <number>
1655 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1656 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1657 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001658 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1659 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1660 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662noepoll
1663 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1664 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001665 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001666
1667nokqueue
1668 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1669 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1670 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1671
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001672noevports
1673 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1674 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1675 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1676 also "nopoll".
1677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001678nopoll
1679 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1680 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001682 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1683 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001684
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001685nosplice
1686 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001688 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001689 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001690 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1691 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1692 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1693 "option splice-response".
1694
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001695nogetaddrinfo
1696 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1697 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1698
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001699noreuseport
1700 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1701 command line argument "-dR".
1702
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001703profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1704 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1705 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1706 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1707 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001708 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001709 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1710 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1711 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1712 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1713
1714 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1715 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1716 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1717 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1718 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001719 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1720 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1721 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1722 CLI.
1723
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001724spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001725 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1726 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1727 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1728 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1729 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1730 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001731
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001732ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001733 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001735 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1736 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1737 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1738 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1739 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1741 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001742 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1743 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1744 openssl configuration file uses:
1745 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1746
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001747ssl-mode-async
1748 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001749 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001750 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1751 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1752 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001753 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001754 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001755
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001756tune.buffers.limit <number>
1757 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1758 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1759 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1760 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1761 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001763 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1764 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1765 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1766 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1767 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1768 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1769 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1770 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1771 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1772
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001773tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1774 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1775 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1776 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1777 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1778
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001779tune.bufsize <number>
1780 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1781 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1782 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1783 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1784 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1785 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1786 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001787 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1788 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1789 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001790 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001791 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1792 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1793 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001794
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001795tune.chksize <number>
1796 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1797 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1798 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1799 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1800 checks whenever possible.
1801
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001802tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1803 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1804 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1805 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1806 this value. The default value is 1.
1807
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001808tune.fail-alloc
1809 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1810 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1811 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1812 gracefully.
1813
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001814tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1815 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1816 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1817 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1818 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1819 change it.
1820
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001821tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1822 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1824 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001825 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1826 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1827 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1828 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1829 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1830
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001831tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1832 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1833 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1834 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1835 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1836 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1837 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1838 recommended not to change this value.
1839
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001840tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1841 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1842 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1843 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1844 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1845 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1846 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1847 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1848
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001849tune.http.cookielen <number>
1850 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1851 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1852 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1853 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1854 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1855 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1856 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1857 to change this value.
1858
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001859tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1861 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001862 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001864 configuration directives too.
1865 The default value is 1024.
1866
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001867tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1868 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1869 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1870 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1871 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1872 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1873 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001874 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1875 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1876 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001877
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001878tune.idletimer <timeout>
1879 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1880 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1881 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1882 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1883 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1884 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001885 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001886 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001887 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1888
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001889tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1890 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1891 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1892 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1893 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1894 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1895 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1896 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1897 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1898 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1899
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001900tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1901 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001902 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001903 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1904 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001905 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001906 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1907 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1908
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001909tune.lua.maxmem
1910 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1911 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1912 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1913 memory.
1914
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001915tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1916 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001917 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1918 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001920
1921tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1922 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1923 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1924 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1925 check servers.
1926
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001927tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1928 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1929 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1930 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001932
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001933tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001934 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1935 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1936 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1937 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1938 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1939 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1940 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1941 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1942 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1943 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001944
1945tune.maxpollevents <number>
1946 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1947 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1948 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1949 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1950 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1951
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001952tune.maxrewrite <number>
1953 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1954 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1955 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1956 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1957 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1958 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1959 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1960 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1961 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1962 bufsize.
1963
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001964tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1965 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1966 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1967 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1968 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1969 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1970 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1971 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1972 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1973 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001974 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1975 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001976 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1977 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1978 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1979 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1980 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1981 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1982 setting this parameter to 0.
1983
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001984tune.pipesize <number>
1985 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1986 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1987 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1988 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1989 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1990 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1991
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001992tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1993 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1994 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1995 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1996 default is 20.
1997
1998tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1999 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2000 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2001 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2002 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2003 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2004 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002005 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002006
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002007tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2008tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2009 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2010 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2011 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002012 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002013 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002014 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2015 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2016
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002017tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002019 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2020 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2021 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2022 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2023
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002024tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002025 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002026 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2027 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2028
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002029tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2030tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2031 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2032 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2033 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002034 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002035 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002036 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2037 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2038 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2039 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2040 notifying haproxy again.
2041
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002042tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002043 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2044 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2045 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002046 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002047 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002048 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002049 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2050 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2051 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002052 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2053 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002054
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002055tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002056 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002057 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2058 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2059 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2060 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2061 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2062
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002063tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2064 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002066 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2067 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2068 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2069 being used for too long.
2070
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002071tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2072 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2073 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2074 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2075 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2076 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2077 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2078 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2079 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2080 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2081 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002082 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002083 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002084
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002085tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2086 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2087 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2088 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2089 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2090 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2091 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2092 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002093 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2094 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002095
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002096tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2097 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2098 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2099 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2100 1000 entries.
2101
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002102tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2103 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2104 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2105 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002107tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002108tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002109tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2110tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2111tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002112 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2113 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2114 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2115 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2116 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2117 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2118 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2119 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002120
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002121 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2122 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2123 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2124 all available space is consumed.
2125 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2126 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2127 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002128
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002129tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2130 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002131 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002132 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002133 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002134 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2135
2136tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2137 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2138 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2140 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021423.3. Debugging
2143--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
2145debug
2146 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2147 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2148 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2149 system startup.
2150
2151quiet
2152 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2153 line argument "-q".
2154
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021563.4. Userlists
2157--------------
2158It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2159http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2160it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2161
2162userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002163 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002164 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2165
2166group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002167 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002168 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2169 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2170
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002171user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2172 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002173 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2174 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002175 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2176 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2177 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2178 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002179
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002180 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2181 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2182 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2183 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2184 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2185 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2186 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2187 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2188 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002189
2190 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002191 userlist L1
2192 group G1 users tiger,scott
2193 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002194
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002195 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2196 user scott insecure-password elgato
2197 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199 userlist L2
2200 group G1
2201 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002202
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002203 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2204 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2205 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002206
2207 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002208
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002209
22103.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002211----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002212It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2213several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2214instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2215values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2216automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2217In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2218using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2219tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2220reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2221Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2222that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2223each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224
2225peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002226 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002227 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2228
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002229bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2230 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2231 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2232
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002233disabled
2234 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2235 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2236 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2237
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002238default-bind [param*]
2239 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2240
2241default-server [param*]
2242 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2243
2244 Arguments:
2245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2246 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2247 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2248 details.
2249
2250
2251 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2252
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002253enable
2254 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2255
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002256log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2257 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2258 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2259 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2260 more details.
2261
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002262peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002263 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2264 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2265 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2266 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2267 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2268 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2269
2270 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2271 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2272
2273 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2274 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2275 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2276 across all peers.
2277
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002278 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2279 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002280
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002281 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2282 "server" keyword explanation below).
2283
2284server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002285 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002286 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2287 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2288 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2289 of this "peers" section).
2290 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2291
2292
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002293 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002294 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002295 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002296 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2297 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2298 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002299
2300 backend mybackend
2301 mode tcp
2302 balance roundrobin
2303 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2304 stick on src
2305
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002306 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2307 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309 Example:
2310 peers mypeers
2311 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2312 default-server ssl verify none
2313 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2314 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002315
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002316
2317table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2318 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2319
2320 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2321 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002322 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002323 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2324 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2325 "stick-table" keyword).
2326
2327 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2328 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2329 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2330 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2331 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2332 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2333 of the stick-table name as follows:
2334
2335 peers mypeers
2336 peer A ...
2337 peer B ...
2338 table t1 ...
2339
2340 frontend fe1
2341 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2342
2343 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2344 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2345
2346 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2347 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2348 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2349 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2350 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2351 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2352 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2353
2354 peers mypeers
2355 peer A ...
2356 peer B ...
2357 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2358
2359 backend t1
2360 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2361
2362 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2363 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2364 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2365
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023663.6. Mailers
2367------------
2368It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2369If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2370in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2371
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002372mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002373 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2374 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2375
2376mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2377 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2378
2379 Example:
2380 mailers mymailers
2381 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2382 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2383
2384 backend mybackend
2385 mode tcp
2386 balance roundrobin
2387
2388 email-alert mailers mymailers
2389 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2390 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2391
2392 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2393 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2394
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002395timeout mail <time>
2396 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2397 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2398 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2399 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2400
2401 Example:
2402 mailers mymailers
2403 timeout mail 20s
2404 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002405
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024063.7. Programs
2407-------------
2408In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2409master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2410managed the same way as the workers.
2411
2412During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2413sequence as a worker:
2414
2415 - the master is re-executed
2416 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2417 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2418 instance of the program
2419
2420During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2421
2422program <name>
2423 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2424 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2425 the management guide).
2426
2427command <command> [arguments*]
2428 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2429 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2430 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2431 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2432
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002433user <user name>
2434 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2435 See also "group".
2436
2437group <group name>
2438 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2439 See also "user".
2440
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002441option start-on-reload
2442no option start-on-reload
2443 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2444 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2445 program section.
2446
2447
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024483.8. HTTP-errors
2449----------------
2450
2451It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2452imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2453several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2454
2455http-errors <name>
2456 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2457 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2458
2459errorfile <code> <file>
2460 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2461
2462 Arguments :
2463 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2464 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2465 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2466
2467 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2468 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2469 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2470 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2471 before any chroot is performed.
2472
2473 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2474
2475 Example:
2476 http-errors website-1
2477 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2478 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2479 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2480
2481 http-errors website-2
2482 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2483 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2484 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2485
2486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002488----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002490Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002491 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002492 - frontend <name>
2493 - backend <name>
2494 - listen <name>
2495
2496A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2497its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2498section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002500
2501A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2502connections.
2503
2504A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2505to forward incoming connections.
2506
2507A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2508parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2511'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2512case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2513
2514Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2515logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2516proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2517However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2518name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2519
2520Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2521and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2524modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2525arbitrary criteria.
2526
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002527In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2528a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002529the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002530
2531 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2532 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2533 between responses and new requests.
2534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002535 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2536 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2537 client-facing connection remains open.
2538
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002539 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2540 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002541
2542The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2543frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2544following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002545weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002546
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002547 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002548
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002549 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2550 ----+-----+-----+----
2551 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2552 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002553 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2554 ----+-----+-----+----
2555 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2560--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002562The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2563limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2564they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2565limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002566marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002567option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002568and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2569with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2570specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002572
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002573 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2575acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576backlog X X X -
2577balance X - X X
2578bind - X X -
2579bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580capture cookie - X X -
2581capture request header - X X -
2582capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002583compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002584cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002585declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586default-server X - X X
2587default_backend X X X -
2588description - X X X
2589disabled X X X X
2590dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002591email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002592email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002593email-alert mailers X X X X
2594email-alert myhostname X X X X
2595email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002596enabled X X X X
2597errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002598errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002599errorloc X X X X
2600errorloc302 X X X X
2601-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2602errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002603force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002604filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002605fullconn X - X X
2606grace X X X X
2607hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002608http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002609http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002611http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002612http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002613http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002614http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002615http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002616id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002617ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002618load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002619log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002620log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002621log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002622log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002623max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002624maxconn X X X -
2625mode X X X X
2626monitor fail - X X -
2627monitor-net X X X -
2628monitor-uri X X X -
2629option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2630option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2631option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2632option allbackups (*) X - X X
2633option checkcache (*) X - X X
2634option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2635option contstats (*) X X X -
2636option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2637option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002638-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2639option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002640option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2641option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002642option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002643option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002644option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002645option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002646option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002647option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2648option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2649option httpchk X - X X
2650option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002651option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002653option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002654option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002655option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002656option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2657option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2658option logasap (*) X X X -
2659option mysql-check X - X X
2660option nolinger (*) X X X X
2661option originalto X X X X
2662option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002663option pgsql-check X - X X
2664option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002665option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002666option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667option smtpchk X - X X
2668option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2669option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2670option splice-request (*) X X X X
2671option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002672option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002673option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2674option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2675-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002676option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002677option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2678option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2679option tcpka X X X X
2680option tcplog X X X X
2681option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002682external-check command X - X X
2683external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2685rate-limit sessions X X X -
2686redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002687-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002688retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002689retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002690server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002691server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002692server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002694stats admin - X X X
2695stats auth X X X X
2696stats enable X X X X
2697stats hide-version X X X X
2698stats http-request - X X X
2699stats realm X X X X
2700stats refresh X X X X
2701stats scope X X X X
2702stats show-desc X X X X
2703stats show-legends X X X X
2704stats show-node X X X X
2705stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2707stick match - - X X
2708stick on - - X X
2709stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002710stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002711stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002712tcp-check connect - - X X
2713tcp-check expect - - X X
2714tcp-check send - - X X
2715tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002716tcp-request connection - X X -
2717tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002718tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002719tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002720tcp-response content - - X X
2721tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002722timeout check X - X X
2723timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002724timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002725timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002726timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2727timeout http-request X X X X
2728timeout queue X - X X
2729timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002730timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002731timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002732timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002734unique-id-format X X X -
2735unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002737use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002738use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2740 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2744---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745
2746This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2747
2748
2749acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2750 Declare or complete an access list.
2751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2752 no | yes | yes | yes
2753 Example:
2754 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2755 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2756 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002758 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002761backlog <conns>
2762 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2764 yes | yes | yes | no
2765 Arguments :
2766 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2767 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002768 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002769
2770 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2771 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2772 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2773 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2774 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2775 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2776 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2777 backlog parameter.
2778
2779 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2780 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2781 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2782
2783 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2784
2785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002787balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 yes | no | yes | yes
2791 Arguments :
2792 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2793 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2794 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2795 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2796
2797 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2798 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2799 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2800 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002801 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002802 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002803 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2804 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2805 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2806 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2807 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2808 it, so that you don't worry.
2809
2810 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2811 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2812 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2813 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2814 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2815 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2816 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2817 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002818
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002819 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2820 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2821 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2822 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2823 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2824 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2825 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2826 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2827
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002828 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002829 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002830 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2831 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002832 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002833 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2834 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2835 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2836 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2837 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002838 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2839 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2840 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2841 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2842 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2843 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2846 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2847 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2848 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2849 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2850 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2851 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2852 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002855 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2856 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2857 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002859 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2860 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2861 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2862 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2863 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2864 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2865 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2866 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2867 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2868 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2869 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2870 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002872 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002873 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2874 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2875 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2876 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2877 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2878 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2879 URIs start with a leading "/".
2880
2881 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2882 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2883 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2884 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002887 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2888
2889 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002890 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2891 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002892 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2893 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2894 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2895 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002896 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002897 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2898 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002899
2900 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2901 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2902 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2903 server will receive the request.
2904
2905 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2906 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2907 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2908 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2909 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002910 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2911 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2912 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002914 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2915 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2916 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2917 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2918 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002920 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002921 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2922 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2923 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2924
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002925 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2926 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2927 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2928
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002929 random
2930 random(<draws>)
2931 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002932 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2933 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2934 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2935 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002936 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2937 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2938 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2939 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2940 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2941 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2942 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2943 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2944 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2945 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2946 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2947 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2948 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2949 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2950 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2951 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2952 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2953 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2954 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2955 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002956
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002957 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002958 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002959 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2960 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2961 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2962 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2963 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2964 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002965 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002966 used instead.
2967
2968 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2969 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2970 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2971 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2972
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002973 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2974 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2975 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2976
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002977 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002980 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2981 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002982
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002983 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2984 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2985 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002987 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002988 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002989 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2990 NTLM relies on.
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 Examples :
2993 balance roundrobin
2994 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002995 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002996 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2997 balance hdr(host)
2998 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002999
3000 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3001 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003003 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003004 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3005 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3006 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003007 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003008
3009 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3010 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3011 defaults to 16 kB.
3012
3013 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3014 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3015
3016 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3017 Round Robin.
3018
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003019 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003020 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3021 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3022 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3023
3024 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3025
3026 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003027 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003028 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3029 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3030 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003032 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033
3034
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003035bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3036bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 no | yes | yes | no
3040 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003041 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3042 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3043 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3044 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003045 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003046 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3047 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3048 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3049 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3050 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3051 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3052 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003053 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3054 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3055 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3056 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3057 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3058 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3059 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003060 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3061 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3062 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003063 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3064 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3065 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3066 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003067 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3068 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3069 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003070
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003071 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3072 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003073 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3074 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3075 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003076 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3077 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3078 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3079 the range.
3080
3081 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3082 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3083 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3084 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3085 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3086 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3087 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003088 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003089 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003091 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003093 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3094 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3095 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3096 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3097 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3098 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003100 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3101 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3102 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3103 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3106 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3107 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3108 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3109 in a frontend.
3110
3111 Example :
3112 listen http_proxy
3113 bind :80,:443
3114 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003115 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003117 listen http_https_proxy
3118 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003119 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003120
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003121 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3122 bind ipv6@:80
3123 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3124 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003126 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003127 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003128
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003129 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3130 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3131 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3132 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3133 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3134
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003135 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003136 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137
3138
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003139bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003140 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143 Arguments :
3144 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3145 may be used to override a default value.
3146
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003147 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003148 option may be combined with other numbers.
3149
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003150 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003151 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3152 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3153 missing from all processes.
3154
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003155 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003156 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003157 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3158 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3159 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3160 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3161 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003162 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003163
3164 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3165 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3166 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3167 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3168 and 'even' instances.
3169
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003170 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3171 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3172 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3173 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003174
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003175 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3176 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3177
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003178 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3179 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3180 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3181
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003182 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3183 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3184
3185 Example :
3186 listen app_ip1
3187 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003188 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003189
3190 listen app_ip2
3191 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003192 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003193
3194 listen management
3195 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003196 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003198 listen management
3199 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3200 bind-process 1-4
3201
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003202 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203
3204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205capture cookie <name> len <length>
3206 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 no | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3211 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3212 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3213 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215
3216 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3217 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3218 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3219 right if it exceeds <length>.
3220
3221 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3222 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3223 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3224 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3225
3226 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3227 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3228 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3229
3230 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3231 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3232 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003233 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3234 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3235 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003236
3237 Example:
3238 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3239
3240 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003241 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242
3243
3244capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003245 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 no | yes | yes | no
3248 Arguments :
3249 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003250 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3252 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3253 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3254
3255 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3256 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3257 it exceeds <length>.
3258
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003259 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3261 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003262 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3263 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3264 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3265 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003266 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003267 environments to find where the request came from.
3268
3269 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3270 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3271 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3272 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003274 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3275 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3276 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3277 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3278 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
3280 Example:
3281 capture request header Host len 15
3282 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003283 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003285 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 about logging.
3287
3288
3289capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003290 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 no | yes | yes | no
3293 Arguments :
3294 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003295 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3297 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3298 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3299
3300 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3301 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3302 it exceeds <length>.
3303
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003304 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3306 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3307 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003308 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3309 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3310 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3311 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003312
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003313 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3314 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3315 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3316 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3317 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003318
3319 Example:
3320 capture response header Content-length len 9
3321 capture response header Location len 15
3322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003323 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324 about logging.
3325
3326
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003327compression algo <algorithm> ...
3328compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003329compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003330 Enable HTTP compression.
3331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | yes | yes | yes
3333 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003334 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3335 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3336 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3337
3338 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003339 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3340 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3341 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003342
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003343 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003344 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003345
3346 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3347 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3348 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3349 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3350 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003351 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003352
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003353 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3354 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3355 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3356 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3357 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3358 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3359 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003360 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003361
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003362 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003363 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003364 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3365 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3366 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3367 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3368 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003369
3370 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3371 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3372 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3373 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3374 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003375 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3376 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3377 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3378 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3379 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003380 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3381 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003382
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003383 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003384 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3385 "Accept-Encoding" header
3386 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003387 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003388 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3389 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3390 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3391 "multipart"
3392 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3393 header
3394 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3395 and later
3396 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3397 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003398 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003399
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003400 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003401
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003402 Examples :
3403 compression algo gzip
3404 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003406
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003407cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003408 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3409 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003410 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 yes | no | yes | yes
3414 Arguments :
3415 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3416 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3417 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3418 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3419 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3420 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3423 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3424
3425 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3426 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3427 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3428 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3429 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3430 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003431 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3432 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003433 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003434 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3435 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436
3437 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003438 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003439
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003440 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003442 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003443 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003444 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3445 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3446 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3447 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3448 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3449 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3450 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
3452 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3453 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3454 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3455 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3456 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3457 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3458 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3459 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3460 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003461 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003462 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3463 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3464 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003466 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3467 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3468 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003469 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3470 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3471 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3472 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003473 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3474 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3475 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
3477 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3478 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3479 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3480 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3481 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3482 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3483 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3484 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3485 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3486
3487 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3488 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3489 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3490 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3491 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3492 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3493 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3494 persistence cookie in the cache.
3495 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3496
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003497 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3498 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3499 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3500 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3501 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003503 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3504 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3505 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3506 they logout.
3507
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003508 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3509 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3510 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3511 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3512
3513 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3514 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3515 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3516 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3517 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3518 this attribute.
3519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003520 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003521 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003522 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3523 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3524 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3525 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3526 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3527 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003528
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003529 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3530 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3531 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3532 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3533 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3534 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3535 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3536 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003537 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003538 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3539 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3540 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3541 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3542 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3543 the site.
3544
3545 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3546 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3547 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3548 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3549 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3550 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3551 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3552 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3553 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3554 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3555 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3556 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3557 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003559 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3560 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3561
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003562 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3563 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3564 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3565 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3566 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3567 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3568
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003569 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3570 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3571 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3572 repeated.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3575 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3576 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3577 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 Examples :
3580 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3581 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3582 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003585 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003587
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003588declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3589 Declares a capture slot.
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 no | yes | yes | no
3592 Arguments:
3593 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3594
3595 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3596 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3597 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3598 for use in the response.
3599
3600 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003601 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003602 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3603
3604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003605default-server [param*]
3606 Change default options for a server in a backend
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | no | yes | yes
3609 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003610 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3611 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3612 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3613 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003614
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003615 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003616 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3617
3618 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621default_backend <backend>
3622 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | no
3625 Arguments :
3626 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3627
3628 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3629 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3630 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3631 will catch all undetermined requests.
3632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Example :
3634
3635 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3636 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3637 default_backend dynamic
3638
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003639 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003642description <string>
3643 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | yes
3646 Arguments : string
3647
3648 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3649 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3650 it describes.
3651 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3652
3653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654disabled
3655 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | yes | yes | yes
3658 Arguments : none
3659
3660 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3661 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3662 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3663 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3664 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3665 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3666 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3667
3668 See also : "enabled"
3669
3670
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003671dispatch <address>:<port>
3672 Set a default server address
3673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003675 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003676
3677 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3678 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3679 during start-up.
3680
3681 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3682 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3683 possible with normal servers.
3684
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003685 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003686 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3687 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3688 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3689 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3690
3691 See also : "server"
3692
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003693
3694dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3695 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | no | yes | yes
3698 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3699
3700 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003701 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003702 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3703 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003704 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003705 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707enabled
3708 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | yes
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3714 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3715
3716 See also : "disabled"
3717
3718
3719errorfile <code> <file>
3720 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723 Arguments :
3724 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003725 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3726 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003727
3728 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003729 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003730 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003731 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3732 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733
3734 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3735 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3736 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3737
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003738 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003740 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3741 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3742 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3743 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3744
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003745 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3746 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003748 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3749 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3750 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3753 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3754 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003755 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3757
3758 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3759
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003760 Example :
3761 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003762 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003763 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3764 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003766
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003767errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3768 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3769 section.
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments :
3773 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3774
3775 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3776 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3777 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3778
3779 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3780 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3781 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3782 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3783 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3784 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3785 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3786
3787 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3788 3.8 about http-errors.
3789
3790 Example :
3791 errorfiles generic
3792 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3793
3794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795errorloc <code> <url>
3796errorloc302 <code> <url>
3797 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3799 yes | yes | yes | yes
3800 Arguments :
3801 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003802 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3803 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003804
3805 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3806 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3807 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3808 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003809 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003810
3811 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3812 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3813 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3814
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003815 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003817 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3818 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3819 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3820 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003821 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003822 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3823 request.
3824
3825 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3826
3827
3828errorloc303 <code> <url>
3829 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | yes | yes | yes
3832 Arguments :
3833 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003834 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3835 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003836
3837 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3838 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3839 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3840 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003841 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003842
3843 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3844 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3845 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3846
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003847 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3850 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3851 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3852 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003853 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003854
3855 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3856
3857
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858email-alert from <emailaddr>
3859 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | yes | yes | yes
3863
3864 Arguments :
3865
3866 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3867
3868 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3869 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3870
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003871 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003872 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3873 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003874
3875
3876email-alert level <level>
3877 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3878 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881
3882 Arguments :
3883
3884 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3885 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3886 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3887
3888 By default level is alert
3889
3890 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3891 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3892 for the proxy.
3893
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003894 Alerts are sent when :
3895
3896 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3897 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3898 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3899 is notice or lower
3900 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3901 and a health check status update occurs
3902
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003903 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3904 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003905 section 3.6 about mailers.
3906
3907
3908email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3909 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912
3913 Arguments :
3914
3915 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3916
3917 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3918 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3919
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3921 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003922
3923
3924email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3925 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3926 mailers.
3927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | yes
3929
3930 Arguments :
3931
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003932 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003933
3934 By default the systems hostname is used.
3935
3936 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3937 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3938 for the proxy.
3939
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003940 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3941 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003942
3943
3944email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003945 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003946 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3948 yes | yes | yes | yes
3949
3950 Arguments :
3951
3952 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3953
3954 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3955 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003958 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3959
3960
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003961force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3962 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003964 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003965
3966 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3967 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3968 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3969 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3970 marked down for maintenance operations.
3971
3972 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3973 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3974 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3975 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3976 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3977 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3978 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3979 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3980 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3981
3982 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3983 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3984 is used.
3985
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003986 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003987 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003988
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003989
3990filter <name> [param*]
3991 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 no | yes | yes | yes
3994 Arguments :
3995 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3996 referenced in section 9.
3997
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003998 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003999 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004000 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4001 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004002
4003 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4004 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4005
4006 Example:
4007 listen
4008 bind *:80
4009
4010 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4011 filter compression
4012 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4013
4014 compression algo gzip
4015 compression offload
4016
4017 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4018
4019 See also : section 9.
4020
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004022fullconn <conns>
4023 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
4027 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4028 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4029
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004030 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004031 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004032 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4034 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4035 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4036 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4037 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004038 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004039
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004040 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4041 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004042 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4043 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4044 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004045
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004046 Example :
4047 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4048 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4049 # connections.
4050 backend dynamic
4051 fullconn 10000
4052 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4053 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4054
4055 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4056
4057
4058grace <time>
4059 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004062 Arguments :
4063 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4064 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4065 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4066
4067 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4068 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004069 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004070 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4071
4072 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4073 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4074 simplify it.
4075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004077hash-balance-factor <factor>
4078 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | no | no | yes
4081 Arguments :
4082 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4083 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004084 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004085
4086 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4087 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4088 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4089 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4090 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4091 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4092 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4093
4094 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4095 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4096 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4097 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4098 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4099
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004100 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4101 consistent hashing mechanism.
4102
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004103 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4104
4105
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004106hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | no | yes | yes
4110 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004111 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4112 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004113
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004114 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4115 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4116 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4117 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4118 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4119 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4120 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4121 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4122 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4123 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004124
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004125 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4126 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4127 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4128 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4129 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4130 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4131 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4132 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4133 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4134 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4135 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4136 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4137 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004138 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4139 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004140
4141 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4142
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004143 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004144 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4145 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4146 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004147 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4148 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4149 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004150
4151 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4152 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004153 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4154 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4155 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4156 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4157
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004158 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4159 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4160 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4161 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4162 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4163 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4164 parameter.
4165
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004166 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4167 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4168 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4169 used on strings.
4170
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004171 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4172
4173 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4174 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4175 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4176 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4177 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4178 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4179 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4180 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4181 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4182 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4183 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4184 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004185
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004186 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4187 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4188 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004189
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004190 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004191
4192
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004193http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4194 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4195 ones).
4196
4197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 no | yes | yes | yes
4199
4200 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4201 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4202 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4203 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4204 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4205 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4206
4207 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4208 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4209 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4210
4211 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4212 below.
4213
4214 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4215 instance.
4216
4217 Example:
4218 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4219 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4220 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4221
4222http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4223
4224 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4225 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4226 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4227 example, or to pass some internal information.
4228 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4229 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4230 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4231
4232http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4233
4234 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4235 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4236
4237http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4238
4239 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4240
4241http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4242 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4243
4244 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4245
4246 Example:
4247 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4248
4249 # applied to:
4250 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4251
4252 # outputs:
4253 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4254
4255 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4256
4257http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4259
4260 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4261
4262 Example:
4263 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4264
4265 # applied to:
4266 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4267
4268 # outputs:
4269 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4270
4271http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4272
4273 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4274 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4275 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4276
4277http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4278 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4281 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4282 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4283 fallback.
4284
4285 Example:
4286 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4287 http-response set-status 431
4288 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4289 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4290
4291http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4294 inline.
4295
4296 Arguments:
4297 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4298 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4299 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4302 (request and response)
4303 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4304 processing
4305 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4306 processing
4307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4308 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4309 and '_'.
4310
4311 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4312 followed by some converters.
4313
4314 Example:
4315 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4316
4317http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4318
4319 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4320 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4321 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4322 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4323 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4324 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
4325 processing.
4326
4327 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4328 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4329 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4330 rules evaluation.
4331
4332http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4335 details about <var-name>.
4336
4337 Example:
4338 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4339
4340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341http-check disable-on-404
4342 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345 Arguments : none
4346
4347 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4348 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4349 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4350 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4351 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4352 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4353 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4354 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004355 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4356 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4357 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4358
4359 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4360
4361
4362http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004363 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004365 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004366 Arguments :
4367 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4368 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004369 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004370 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4371 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4372 details on the supported keywords.
4373
4374 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4375 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4376 with the usual backslash ('\').
4377
4378 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4379 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4380 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4381 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4382 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4383
4384 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004385 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004386 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4387 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4388 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4389
4390 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004391 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004392 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4393 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4394 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4395 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4396
4397 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004398 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004399 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4400 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4401 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4402 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4403 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004404 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004405 trace).
4406
4407 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004409 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4410 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4411 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4412 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4413 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004414 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004415
4416 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4417 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4418 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4419 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4420 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4421 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4422 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4423 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4424
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004425 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4426 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4427 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4428
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004429 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4430 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4431
4432 Examples :
4433 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004434 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004435
4436 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004437 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004438
4439 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004440 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004441
4442 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004443 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004444
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004445 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
4447
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004448http-check send-state
4449 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | no | yes | yes
4452 Arguments : none
4453
4454 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4455 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4456 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4457 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4458 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4459
4460 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4461 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4462 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4463 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4464 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004465 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4466 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4467 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4468
4469 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4470 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4471 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4472
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004473 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4474 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4475 checked in multiple backends.
4476
4477 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4478 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4479
4480 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4481 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4482 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4483 one fails.
4484
4485 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4486 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4487 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4488
4489 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4490 server's queue.
4491
4492 Example of a header received by the application server :
4493 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4494 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4495
4496 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498
4499http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004500 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4501
4502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 no | yes | yes | yes
4504
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004505 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4506 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4507 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4508 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4509 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4512 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 Example:
4517 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4518 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4519 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521 http-request allow if nagios
4522 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4523 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4524 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526 Example:
4527 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4528 acl add path /addacl
4529 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4534 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Example:
4537 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4538 acl setmap path /setmap
4539 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4544 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4547 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004551 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4552 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4553 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4554 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4555 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4556 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4557 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4558 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4563 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4564 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4565 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4566 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4567 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4568 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4569 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4574 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004575
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4580 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4581 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4582 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4583 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585 Example:
4586 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4587 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004589http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004590
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004591 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4594 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4597 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4598 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4599 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4600 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4601 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4602 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4603 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4604 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4607 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4608 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004609 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4610
4611 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4612 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4613 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4614 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4619 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4620 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4621 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4622 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4623 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4632 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4633 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4634 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4635 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4636 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004637
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004638http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4642 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4643 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004644 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4645 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4646 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4647 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4648 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004650
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004651http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4652 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4653 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4654 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4655
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004656http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4657
4658 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4659 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4660 pointed by <resolvers>.
4661 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4662 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4663 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4664 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4665 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4666 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4667 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4668 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4669 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4670 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4671 to 0.0.0.0.
4672
4673 Example:
4674 resolvers mydns
4675 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4676 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4677 timeout retry 1s
4678 hold valid 10s
4679 hold nx 3s
4680 hold other 3s
4681 hold obsolete 0s
4682 accepted_payload_size 8192
4683
4684 frontend fe
4685 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4686 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4687 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4688
4689 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4690 # which mean DNS resolution error
4691 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4692
4693 default_backend be
4694
4695 backend b_503
4696 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4697 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4698 # 503 error page to end users
4699
4700 backend be
4701 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4702 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4703 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4704 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4705 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4706
4707 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4708 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4709
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004710http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4711
4712 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4713 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4714 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4715 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004716 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4717 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004718
4719 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4724 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4725 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4726 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4727 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004729http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004731 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4732 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4733 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4734 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004738
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004739 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4740 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4741 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4742 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4743 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4744 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004745
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004746 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4747 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4748 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4749 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4750 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004751
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004752 Example:
4753 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4754
4755 # applied to:
4756 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4757
4758 # outputs:
4759 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4760
4761 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004762
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004763 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4764
4765 # applied to:
4766 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004767
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004768 # outputs:
4769 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004770
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004771http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4773
4774 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4775 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4776 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4777 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4778
4779 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4780 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4781 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4782
4783 Example:
4784 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4785 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4786
4787 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4788 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4789
4790 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4791 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4792 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4793 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4794
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004795http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4796 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4797
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004798 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4799 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4800 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4801 against.
4802
4803 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4804 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4805 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004806
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004807 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4808 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4809 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4810 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4811 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4812 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4813 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4814 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4815 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004816 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4817 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004818
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004819 Example:
4820 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4821 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004822
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004823 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4824 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4827 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004828
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004829 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4830 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4831 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4832 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004833
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004834 Example:
4835 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004836
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004837 # applied to:
4838 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004839
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004840 # outputs:
4841 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004842
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004843http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4844 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4845 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004846 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004847 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4848
4849 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediatly returns a response. The
4850 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4851 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4852 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4853 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
4854 or the response payload specifing the file or the string to use. These rules
4855 are followed to create the response :
4856
4857 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4858 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4859 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4860 ignored.
4861
4862 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4863 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4864 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4865 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4866 ignored.
4867
4868 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4869 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4870 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4871 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4872 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4873
4874 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4875 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4876 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4877 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4878 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4879 if any, is ignored.
4880
4881 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4882 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4883 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4884 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4885 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4886 as a raw content.
4887
4888 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4889 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4890 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4891 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4892 considered as a raw string.
4893
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004894 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4895 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4896 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4897 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4898
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004899 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4900 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4901 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4902
4903 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4904
4905 Example:
4906 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4907 if { path /ping }
4908
4909 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4910 if { path /favicon.ico }
4911
4912 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4913 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4914 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004916http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4917http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004919 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4920 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4921 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004922
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004923http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4924 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004925
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004926 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4927 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4928 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4929 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004931http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004933 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4934 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4935 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4936 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4937 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004938
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004939 Arguments:
4940 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4941 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004943 Example:
4944 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4945 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004947 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4948 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004950http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004952 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4953 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4954 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004956 Arguments:
4957 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4958 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004960 Example:
4961 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4962 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004963
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004964 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4965 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4966 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004968http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004970 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4971 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4972 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4973 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4974 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004975
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004976 Example:
4977 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4978 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4979 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4980 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4981 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4982 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4983 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4984 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4985 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4990 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4991 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4992 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4993 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004995http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4996 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004998 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4999 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5000 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5001 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5002 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5003 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5004 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5005 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5006 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005008http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005010 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5011 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5012 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5013 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5014 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5015 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5016 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005018http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005020 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5021 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5022 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005024http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005026 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5027 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5028 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5029 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5030 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5031 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5032 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5033 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005035http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005037 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5038 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5039 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5040 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5041 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5042 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044 Example :
5045 # prepend the host name before the path
5046 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005048http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005050 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5051 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5052 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5053 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5054 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005056http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005058 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5059 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5060 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5061 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5062 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5063 values have higher priority.
5064 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5065 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5066 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5067 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5068 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005070http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005072 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5073 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5074 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5075 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5076 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5077 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5078 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005080 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005081
5082 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5084 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5087 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5088 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5089 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
5090 privacy.
5091
5092 Arguments :
5093 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5094 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005095
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005096 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5098 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5099
5100 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5101 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5102
5103http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104
5105 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5106 expression.
5107
5108 Arguments:
5109 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5110 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005111
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005112 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5114 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5115
5116 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5117 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5118 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5119
5120http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5121
5122 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5123 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5124 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5125 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5126 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5127 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5128 information from the request.
5129
5130 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5131
5132http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5133
5134 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5135 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5136 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5137 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5138 path and the query string.
5139 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5140
5141http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5142
5143 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5144 inline.
5145
5146 Arguments:
5147 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5148 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5149 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5150 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5151 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5152 (request and response)
5153 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5154 processing
5155 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5156 processing
5157 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5158 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5159 and '_'.
5160
5161 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5162 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005163
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005164 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005165 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005167http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5168 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005170 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5171 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5172 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5173 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5174 agent name must be used.
5175
5176 Arguments:
5177 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5178
5179 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5180 configuration.
5181
5182http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5183
5184 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5185 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5186 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5187 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5188 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5189 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5190 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5191 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5192 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5193 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5194 action.
5195 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5196 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5197 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5198 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5199 you fully understand how it works.
5200
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005201http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5202
5203 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5204 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5205 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5206 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5207 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5208 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
5209 processing.
5210
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005211 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005212 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5213 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5214 rules evaluation.
5215
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005216http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5217 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005218
5219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5220 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5221 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5222 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5223 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5224 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5225 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5226 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5227 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5228 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5229 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005230 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5231 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5232 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5233 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5234 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005235 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5236
5237http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5239http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5240
5241 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5242 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5243 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5244 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5245 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5246 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5247 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5248 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5249 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5250 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5251 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5252 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5253
5254 Arguments :
5255 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5256 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5257 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5258 select which table entry to update the counters.
5259
5260 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5261 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5262 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5263 that table until the session ends.
5264
5265 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5266 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5267 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5268 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5269 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5270 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5271 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5272 useful information.
5273
5274 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5275 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5276 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5277 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5278 checks that make use of it.
5279
5280http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5281
5282 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005283
5284 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005286
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005287http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5288
5289 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5290 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5291 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5292 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5293 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5294 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5295
5296 Arguments :
5297 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5298
5299 Example:
5300 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005302http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005304 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5305 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5306 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005307
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005309http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005310 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5311
5312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 no | yes | yes | yes
5314
5315 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5316 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5317 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5318 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5319 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5320 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005322 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5323 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005325 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005327 Example:
5328 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005330 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005331
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005332 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5333 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005335 Example:
5336 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005337
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005338 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005340 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5341 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005343 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5344 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005346http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005347
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005348 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5349 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5350 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5351 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5352 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5353 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5354 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5355 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005357http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005359 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5360 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5361 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5362 example, or to pass some internal information.
5363 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5364 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5365 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005367http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005368
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005369 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5370 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005371
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005372http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005373
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005374 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005376http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005378 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5379 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5380 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5381 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5382 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5383 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5384 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005386 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5387 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5388 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5389 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5390 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005391
5392 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5393 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5394 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5395 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005396
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005397http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005398
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005399 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5400 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5401 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5402 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5403 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5404 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005405
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005406http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005407
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005408 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005410http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005412 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5413 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5414 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5415 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5416 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5417 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005418
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005419http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5420 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005422 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005423 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5424 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005425 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5426 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5427 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5428 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5429 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005430 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005432http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005433
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005434 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5435 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5436 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5437 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5438 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5439 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005441http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5442 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005443
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005444 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5445 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005447 Example:
5448 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005450 # applied to:
5451 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005453 # outputs:
5454 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005456 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005458http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5459 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005460
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005461 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005462 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005464 Example:
5465 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005466
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005467 # applied to:
5468 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005469
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005470 # outputs:
5471 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005472
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005473http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5474 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5475 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005476 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5478
5479 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediatly returns a response. The
5480 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5481 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5482 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5483 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
5484 or the response payload specifing the file or the string to use. These rules
5485 are followed to create the response :
5486
5487 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5488 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5489 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5490 ignored.
5491
5492 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5493 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5494 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5495 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5496 ignored.
5497
5498 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5499 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5500 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5501 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5502 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5503
5504 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5505 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5506 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5507 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5508 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5509 if any, is ignored.
5510
5511 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5512 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5513 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5514 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5515 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5516 as a raw content.
5517
5518 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5519 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5520 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5521 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5522 considered as a raw string.
5523
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005524 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5525 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5526 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5527 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5528
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005529 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5530 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5531 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5532
5533 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5534
5535 Example:
5536 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5537 if { status eq 404 }
5538
5539 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5540 string "This is the end !" \
5541 if { status eq 500 }
5542
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005543http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5544http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005545
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005546 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5547 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5548 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005549
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005550http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5551 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005552
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005553 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5554 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5555 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5556 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005558http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005560 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5561 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5562 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5563 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5564 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005566 Arguments:
5567 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005569 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5570 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005572http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005573
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005574 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5575 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5576 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005577
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005578http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5579
5580 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5581 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5582 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5583 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5584 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5585
5586http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5587
5588 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5589 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5590 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5591 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5592 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5593 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5594 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5595 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5596 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5597
5598http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5599
5600 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5601 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5602 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5603 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5604 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5605 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5606 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5607
5608http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5609
5610 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5611 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5612 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5613 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5614 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5615 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5616 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5617 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5618
5619http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5621
5622 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5623 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5624 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5625 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005626
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005627 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005628 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5629 http-response set-status 431
5630 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5631 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005633http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005634
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005635 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5636 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5637 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5638 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5639 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5640 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5641 based on some information from the request.
5642
5643 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5644
5645http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5646
5647 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5648 inline.
5649
5650 Arguments:
5651 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5652 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5656 (request and response)
5657 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5658 processing
5659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5660 processing
5661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5662 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5663 and '_'.
5664
5665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5666 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005667
5668 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005669 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005670
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005671http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005673 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5674 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5675 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5676 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5677 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5678 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5679 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5680 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5681 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5682 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5683 action.
5684 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5685 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5686 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5687 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5688 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005689
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005690http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5691
5692 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5693 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5694 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5695 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5696 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5697 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5698 processing.
5699
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005700 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005701 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5702 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5703 rules evaluation.
5704
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005705http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5706http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5707http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005709 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5710 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5711 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5712 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5713 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5714 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5715
5716http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5717
5718 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5719 about <var-name>.
5720
5721 Example:
5722 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5723
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005724
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005725http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5726 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5727
5728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | no | yes | yes
5730
5731 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005732 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5733 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5734 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005735
5736 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5737
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005738 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5739 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5740 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5741 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5742 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5743 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5744 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5745 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5746 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5747 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005748
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005749 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5750 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5751 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5752 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5753 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5754 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5755 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5756 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005757
5758 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5759 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5760 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5761 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5762 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5763 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5764 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5765 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005766 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005767 downsides of rare connection failures.
5768
5769 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5770 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5771 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5772 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5773 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5774 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005775 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005776 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5777 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5778 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5779 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5780 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5781
5782 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005783 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5784 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5785 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005786
5787 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005788 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005789
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005790 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5791 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005792
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005793 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005794
5795 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5796 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5797 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5798
5799 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5800
5801
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005802http-send-name-header [<header>]
5803 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005806 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005807 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5808
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005809 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5810 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5811 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5812 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5813 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5814 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5815 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5816 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5817 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5818 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5819 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5820 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5821 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5822 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5823 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5824 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005825
5826 See also : "server"
5827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005828id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005829 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5831 no | yes | yes | yes
5832 Arguments : none
5833
5834 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5835 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5836 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005837
5838
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005839ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5840 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5841 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005842 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005843
5844 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5845 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5846 and running).
5847
5848 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5849 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5850 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005851 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005852 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5853
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005854 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5855 "unless" condition is met.
5856
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005857 Example:
5858 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5859 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5860 ignore-persist if url_static
5861
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005862 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5863
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005864load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5865 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 yes | no | yes | yes
5868
5869 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5870 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5871 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005872 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005873 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5874 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5875 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5876 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5877
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005878 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005879 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005880 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005881
5882 Arguments:
5883 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5884 named "server-state-file".
5885
5886 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5887 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5888 name is used as a file name.
5889
5890 none don't load any stat for this backend
5891
5892 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005893 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5894 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5895 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005896 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005897 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005898
5899 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5900 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5901
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005902 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005903
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005904 global
5905 stats socket /tmp/socket
5906 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005907
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005908 defaults
5909 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005910
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005911 backend bk
5912 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5913 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005914
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005915
5916 Then one can run :
5917
5918 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5919
5920 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5921
5922 1
5923 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5924 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5925 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5926
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005927 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005928
5929 global
5930 stats socket /tmp/socket
5931 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5932
5933 defaults
5934 load-server-state-from-file local
5935
5936 backend bk
5937 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5938 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5939
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005940
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005941 Then one can run :
5942
5943 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5944
5945 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5946
5947 1
5948 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5949 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5950 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5951
5952 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5953 "show servers state"
5954
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005955
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005956log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005957log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5958 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005959no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005960 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005963
5964 Prefix :
5965 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5966 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5967 prefix does not allow arguments.
5968
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005969 Arguments :
5970 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5971 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5972 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5973 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5974 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5975 parameter.
5976
5977 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5978 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5979
5980 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5981 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5982 standard syslog port).
5983
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005984 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5985 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5986 standard syslog port).
5987
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005988 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5989 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5990 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005991 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005992
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005993 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5994 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5995 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5996 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5997 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5998 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5999 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6000 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6001 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6002 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6003 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6004 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6005 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6006 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6007 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6008 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006009 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6010 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006011
6012 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6013 and "fd@2", see above.
6014
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006015 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6016 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6017 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6018 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6019 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6020 having the logs instantly available.
6021
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006022 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6023 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006024
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006025 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6026 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6027 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6028 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6029 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6030 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6031 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6032 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6033 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6034 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006035 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006036
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006037 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6038 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6039 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6040 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6041 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6042
6043 <sample_size>
6044 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6045 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6046 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6047 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6048 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6049
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006050 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6051 one of the following :
6052
6053 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6055
6056 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6057 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6058
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006059 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6060 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6061 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6062 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6063 systemd logger consumes.
6064
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006065 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6066 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6067 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6068 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6069
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006070 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6071
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006072 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6073 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6074 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6075
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006076 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6077 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6078 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6079 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006080
6081 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6082 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6083 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006084 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6085 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6086 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6087 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6088 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006089
6090 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6091
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006092 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6093 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6094 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006095
6096 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6097 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6098 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6099 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6100
6101 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6102 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006103
6104 Example :
6105 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006106 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6107 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6108 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006109 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6110 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006111 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006112
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006113
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006114log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006115 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6116 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006118
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006119 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6120 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6121 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6122 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6123 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006124
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006125 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6126 "option httplog" directives.
6127
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006128log-format-sd <string>
6129 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6130 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6131 yes | yes | yes | no
6132
6133 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6134 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6135 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6136 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6137 which covers the log format string in depth.
6138
6139 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6140 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6141
6142 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6143 log format to "rfc5424".
6144
6145 Example :
6146 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6147
6148
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006149log-tag <string>
6150 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6152 yes | yes | yes | yes
6153
6154 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6155 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6156 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6157 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6158 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6159 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6160 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6161 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6162 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006163
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006164max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6165 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | no | yes | yes
6168
6169 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6170 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6171 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6172 servers.
6173
6174 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6175 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6176 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6177 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6178 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006179 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006180 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6181 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6182 picking a different server.
6183
6184 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6185 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6186 even if they have to be queued.
6187
6188 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6189 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6190
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006191max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6192 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6193 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6194 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006196maxconn <conns>
6197 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | yes | yes | no
6200 Arguments :
6201 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6202 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6203 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6204 closes.
6205
6206 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6207 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6208 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6209 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006210 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6211 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6212 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6213 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006214
6215 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6216 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6217 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6218
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006219 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6220 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006221
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006222 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6223
6224
6225mode { tcp|http|health }
6226 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | yes | yes | yes
6229 Arguments :
6230 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6231 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6232 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6233 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6234
6235 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6236 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6237 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6238 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6239 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6240
6241 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006242 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6243 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6244 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6245 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6246 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6247 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6248 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006249
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006250 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6251 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6252 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006253
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006254 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006255 defaults http_instances
6256 mode http
6257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006258 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006260
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006261monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006262 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006265 Arguments :
6266 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6267 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006268 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006269 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6270 backend and its backup.
6271
6272 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6273 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6274 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6275 servers in a list of backends.
6276
6277 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6278 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6279 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6280 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6281 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6282 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6283 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006284 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6285 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006286
6287 Example:
6288 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006289 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006290 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6291 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6292 monitor-uri /site_alive
6293 monitor fail if site_dead
6294
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006295 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006296
6297
6298monitor-net <source>
6299 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6301 yes | yes | yes | no
6302 Arguments :
6303 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6304 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6305 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6306 followed by a mask.
6307
6308 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6309 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006310 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006311 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6312
6313 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6314 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6315 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6316 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006317 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6318 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6319 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006320
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006321 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6322 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6323 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6324 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6325 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6326 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006327
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006328 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6329 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006330
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006331 Example :
6332 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6333 frontend www
6334 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6335
6336 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6337
6338
6339monitor-uri <uri>
6340 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6342 yes | yes | yes | no
6343 Arguments :
6344 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6345 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6346
6347 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6348 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6349 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6350 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6351 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6352 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6353 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6354 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6355
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006356 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006357 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6358 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6359 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6360 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6361 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6362 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006363
6364 Example :
6365 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6366 frontend www
6367 mode http
6368 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6369
6370 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006372
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006373option abortonclose
6374no option abortonclose
6375 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | no | yes | yes
6378 Arguments : none
6379
6380 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6381 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6382 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6383 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006384 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006385 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6386 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6387 encountered while delivering the response.
6388
6389 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6390 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6391 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6392 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6393 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6394 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006395 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006396 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006397 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006398 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6399 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6400 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006402 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6403 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006404 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6405 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6406 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6407 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6408 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6409 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006410 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006411
6412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6414
6415 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6416
6417
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006418option accept-invalid-http-request
6419no option accept-invalid-http-request
6420 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 yes | yes | yes | no
6423 Arguments : none
6424
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006425 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006426 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006427 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006428 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6429 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6430 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6431 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6432 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006433 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6434 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6435 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6436 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006437 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006438 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006439 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6440 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6441 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006442
6443 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6444 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6445 been confirmed.
6446
6447 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6448 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006449 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6450 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006451 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6452
6453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6455
6456 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6457 stats socket.
6458
6459
6460option accept-invalid-http-response
6461no option accept-invalid-http-response
6462 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | no | yes | yes
6465 Arguments : none
6466
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006467 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006468 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006469 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006470 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6471 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6472 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6473 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6474 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006475 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6476 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6477 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006478
6479 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6480 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6481 been confirmed.
6482
6483 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6484 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6485 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6486 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6487
6488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6490
6491 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6492 stats socket.
6493
6494
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006495option allbackups
6496no option allbackups
6497 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | no | yes | yes
6500 Arguments : none
6501
6502 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6503 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6504 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6505 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6506 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6507 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6508 order between the backup servers anymore.
6509
6510 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6511 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6512
6513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6515
6516
6517option checkcache
6518no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006519 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | no | yes | yes
6522 Arguments : none
6523
6524 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6525 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006526 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006527 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6528 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006529 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006530
6531 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006532 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006533 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006534 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6535 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006536 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006537 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006538 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6539 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006540 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006541 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6542 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006543 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006544 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6545 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6546 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6547 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6548 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6549 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6550 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6551 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6552 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6553
6554 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006555 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6556 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6557 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6558 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006559
6560 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6561 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006562 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006563 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006564
6565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6567
6568
6569option clitcpka
6570no option clitcpka
6571 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 yes | yes | yes | no
6574 Arguments : none
6575
6576 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6577 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006578 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006579 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6580
6581 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6582 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6583 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6584 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6585
6586 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6587 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6588 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6589 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6590 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6591
6592 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6593
6594 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6595 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6596 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6597
6598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6600
6601 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6602
6603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006604option contstats
6605 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 yes | yes | yes | no
6608 Arguments : none
6609
6610 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6611 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6612 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6613 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006614 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6615 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6616 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6617 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6618 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006619
6620
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006621option dontlog-normal
6622no option dontlog-normal
6623 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6625 yes | yes | yes | no
6626 Arguments : none
6627
6628 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6629 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6630 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6631 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6632 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6633 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6634 logged.
6635
6636 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6637 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6638 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006640 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006641 logging.
6642
6643
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006644option dontlognull
6645no option dontlognull
6646 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6648 yes | yes | yes | no
6649 Arguments : none
6650
6651 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6652 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6653 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6654 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6655 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6656 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006657 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6658 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6659 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006660
6661 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006662 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006663 would not be logged.
6664
6665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6667
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006668 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6669 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006670
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006671
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006672option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006673 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6675 yes | yes | yes | yes
6676 Arguments :
6677 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6678 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006679 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006680 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006681
6682 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6683 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6684 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6685 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6686 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6687 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6688 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006689 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6690 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6691 possible that the client has already brought one.
6692
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006693 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006694 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006695 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006696 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006697 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006698 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006699
6700 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6701 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6702 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6703 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6704 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6705 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6706 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6707
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006708 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6709 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6710 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6711 are under the control of the end-user.
6712
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006713 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006714 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6715 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006716 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6717 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6718 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006719
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006720 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006721 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6722 frontend www
6723 mode http
6724 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6725
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006726 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6727 backend www
6728 mode http
6729 option forwardfor header X-Client
6730
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006731 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006732 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006733
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006734
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006735option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6736no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6737 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6739 yes | yes | yes | no
6740 Arguments : none
6741
6742 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6743 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6744 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6745 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6746 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6747 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6748 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6749
6750 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6751 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6752 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6753 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6754 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6755 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6756 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6757 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6758 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6759 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6760
6761 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6762
6763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6765
6766 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6767 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6768
6769
6770option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6771no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6772 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | no | yes | yes
6775 Arguments : none
6776
6777 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6778 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6779 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6780 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6781 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6782 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6783 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6784
6785 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6786 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6787 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6788 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6789 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6790 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6791 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6792 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6793 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6794 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6795
6796 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6797
6798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6800
6801 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6802 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6803
6804
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006805option http-buffer-request
6806no option http-buffer-request
6807 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6809 yes | yes | yes | yes
6810 Arguments : none
6811
6812 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6813 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6814 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6815 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6816 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6817 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006818 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6819 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6820 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6821 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006822
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006823 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006824
6825
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006826option http-ignore-probes
6827no option http-ignore-probes
6828 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6830 yes | yes | yes | no
6831 Arguments : none
6832
6833 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6834 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6835 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6836 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6837 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6838 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6839 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6840 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6841 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006842 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6843 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006844 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6845
6846 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6847 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6848 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6849 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6850 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6851 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6852 are often the only way to detect them.
6853
6854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6856
6857 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6858
6859
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006860option http-keep-alive
6861no option http-keep-alive
6862 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6864 yes | yes | yes | yes
6865 Arguments : none
6866
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006867 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6868 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006869 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6870 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006871 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6872 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6873 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006874
6875 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6876 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006877 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6878 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6879 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6880 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6881 situations where this option may be useful :
6882
6883 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006884 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006885
6886 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6887 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6888
6889 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6890 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6891 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6892 request.
6893
6894 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6895 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006896 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6897 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6898 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006899
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006900 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6901 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6902 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6903 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6904 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6905 not set.
6906
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006907 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6908 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6909 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006910
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006911 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006912 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006913 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006914
6915
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006916option http-no-delay
6917no option http-no-delay
6918 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | yes
6921 Arguments : none
6922
6923 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6924 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6925 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6926 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6927 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6928 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6929 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6930 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6931 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6932 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6933 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6934 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6935 affected.
6936
6937 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6938 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6939 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6940 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6941 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6942 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6943 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6944 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6945 latency environments.
6946
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006947 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6948
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006949
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006950option http-pretend-keepalive
6951no option http-pretend-keepalive
6952 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006954 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006955 Arguments : none
6956
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006957 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006958 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6959 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6960 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6961 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6962 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6963 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6964 consider the response complete.
6965
6966 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6967 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6968 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6969 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006970 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006971 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6972
6973 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6974 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6975 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6976 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6977 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6978 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6979 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6980
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006981 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6982 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6983 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6984 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6985 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6986 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006987
6988 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6989 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6990
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006991 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006992 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006993
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006994
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006995option http-server-close
6996no option http-server-close
6997 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6999 yes | yes | yes | yes
7000 Arguments : none
7001
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007002 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7003 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7004 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7005 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007006 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7007 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7008 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7009 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7010 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7011 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7012 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7013 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7014 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7015 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7016 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007017
7018 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7019 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7020 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7021 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007022 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7023 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007024
7025 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7026 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007027 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7028 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7029 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007030
7031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7033
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007034 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7035 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007036
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007037option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007038no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007039 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7041 yes | yes | yes | no
7042 Arguments : none
7043
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007044 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007045 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7046 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7047 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7048 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7049 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7050 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7051
7052 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7053 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007054 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7055 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7056 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007057
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007058 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7059 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7060 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7061 front of an existing proxy.
7062
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007063 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7064
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007065 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007066
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007067option httpchk
7068option httpchk <uri>
7069option httpchk <method> <uri>
7070option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7071 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7073 yes | no | yes | yes
7074 Arguments :
7075 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7076 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7077 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7078 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7079 ones.
7080
7081 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7082 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7083 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7084
7085 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7086 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7087 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7088 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7089 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7090
7091 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7092 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7093 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7094 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7095 the lack of any response.
7096
7097 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7098
7099 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7100 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7101 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7102
7103 Examples :
7104 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7105 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7106 backend https_relay
7107 mode tcp
7108 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7109 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7110
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007111 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7112 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7113 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007114
7115
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007116option httpclose
7117no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007118 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | yes | yes | yes
7121 Arguments : none
7122
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007123 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7124 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7125 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7126 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007127 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007128
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007129 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7130 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007131 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007132 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7133 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007134
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007135 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7136 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7137 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007138
7139 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7140 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007141 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7142 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7143 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007148 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007149
7150
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007151option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007152 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007154 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007155 Arguments :
7156 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7157 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7158 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007159 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007160 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007161
7162 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7163 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7164 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7165 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7166 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7167 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7168 ports.
7169
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007170 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7171 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007172
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007173 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007175 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007176
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007177
7178option http_proxy
7179no option http_proxy
7180 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7182 yes | yes | yes | yes
7183 Arguments : none
7184
7185 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7186 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7187 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7188 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7189 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7190
7191 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7192 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007193 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7194 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007195
7196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7198
7199 Example :
7200 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7201 backend direct_forward
7202 option httpclose
7203 option http_proxy
7204
7205 See also : "option httpclose"
7206
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007207
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007208option independent-streams
7209no option independent-streams
7210 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7212 yes | yes | yes | yes
7213 Arguments : none
7214
7215 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7216 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7217 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7218 receive data or not.
7219
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007220 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007221 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7222 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7223 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7224 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7225 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7226 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7227 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7228 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7229 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7230 socket buffers.
7231
7232 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7233 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7234 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7235 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7236 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7237
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007238 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007239
7240
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007241option ldap-check
7242 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7244 yes | no | yes | yes
7245 Arguments : none
7246
7247 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7248 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7249 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7250 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7251
7252 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7253 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7254
7255 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7256 configure it.
7257
7258 Example :
7259 option ldap-check
7260
7261 See also : "option httpchk"
7262
7263
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007264option external-check
7265 Use external processes for server health checks
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 yes | no | yes | yes
7268
7269 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7270 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7271 command".
7272
7273 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7274
7275 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7276
7277
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007278option log-health-checks
7279no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007280 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7282 yes | no | yes | yes
7283 Arguments : none
7284
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007285 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7286 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7287 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007288
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007289 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7290 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7291 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7292 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7293 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007295 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007296 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007297
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007298 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7299 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7300 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007301
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007302
7303option log-separate-errors
7304no option log-separate-errors
7305 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7307 yes | yes | yes | no
7308 Arguments : none
7309
7310 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7311 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7312 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7313 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7314 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7315 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7316 provides very important information.
7317
7318 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7319 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7320 error logs.
7321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007322 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007323 logging.
7324
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007325
7326option logasap
7327no option logasap
7328 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7330 yes | yes | yes | no
7331 Arguments : none
7332
7333 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7334 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7335 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7336 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7337 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7338 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7339 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007340 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007341 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7342 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007344 Examples :
7345 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7346 mode http
7347 option httplog
7348 option logasap
7349 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7350
7351 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7352 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7353 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7354 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007356 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007357 logging.
7358
7359
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007360option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007361 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7363 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007364 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007365 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7366 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007367 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007368
7369 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7370 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007371 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007372 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7373 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7374 in the MySQL table, like this :
7375
7376 USE mysql;
7377 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7378 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7379
7380 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007381 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007382 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7383 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7384 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7385 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7386 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7387 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7388 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7389
7390 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7391 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007392
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007393 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007394
7395 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7396 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7397 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7398 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007399 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7400 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007401
7402 See also: "option httpchk"
7403
7404
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007405option nolinger
7406no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007407 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007408 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007410 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007411
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007412 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007413 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7414 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7415 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7416 connections.
7417
7418 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7419 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7420 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7421 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7422 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7423 this too.
7424
7425 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7426 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7427 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7428
7429 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7430 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7431 for servers.
7432
7433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7435
7436
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007437option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7438 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7440 yes | yes | yes | yes
7441 Arguments :
7442 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7443 matching <network>
7444 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7445 header name.
7446
7447 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7448 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7449 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7450 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7451 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7452 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7453 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7454 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7455 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7456 possible that the client has already brought one.
7457
7458 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7459 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7460 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7461 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7462 header and requires different one.
7463
7464 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7465 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7466 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7467 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7468 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7469 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7470 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7471
7472 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7473 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7474 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7475 both are defined.
7476
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007477 Examples :
7478 # Original Destination address
7479 frontend www
7480 mode http
7481 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7482
7483 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7484 backend www
7485 mode http
7486 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7487
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007488 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007489
7490
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007491option persist
7492no option persist
7493 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7495 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007496 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007497
7498 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7499 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7500 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7501 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7502 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7503 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7504 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7505 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7506 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7507 redirected to another valid server.
7508
7509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7511
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007512 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007513
7514
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007515option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7516 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7518 yes | no | yes | yes
7519 Arguments :
7520 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7521 PostgreSQL server.
7522
7523 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7524 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7525 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7526 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7527
7528 See also: "option httpchk"
7529
7530
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007531option prefer-last-server
7532no option prefer-last-server
7533 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | no | yes | yes
7536 Arguments : none
7537
7538 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7539 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7540 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7541 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7542 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7543 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7544 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7545 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7546 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007547 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7548 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007549 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7550 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7551 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007552 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7553 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7554 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007555
7556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7558
7559 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7560
7561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007562option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007563option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007564no option redispatch
7565 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7567 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007568 Arguments :
7569 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7570 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7571 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007572 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007573 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007574 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007575 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7576 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7577 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007579
7580 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7581 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7582 be able to access the service anymore.
7583
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007584 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7585 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007586
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007587 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007588 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7589 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7593
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007594 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007595
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007596
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007597option redis-check
7598 Use redis health checks for server testing
7599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7600 yes | no | yes | yes
7601 Arguments : none
7602
7603 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7604 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7605 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7606 find the "+PONG" response message.
7607
7608 Example :
7609 option redis-check
7610
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007611 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007612
7613
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007614option smtpchk
7615option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7616 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7618 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007620 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007621 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007622 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7623
7624 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7625 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7626 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7627
7628 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7629 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7630 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7631 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7632 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7633 dead server.
7634
7635 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7636 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007637 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007638 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7639
7640 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7641 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7642 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7643 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007644 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007645
7646 Example :
7647 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7648
7649 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007652option socket-stats
7653no option socket-stats
7654
7655 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7657 yes | yes | yes | no
7658
7659 Arguments : none
7660
7661
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007662option splice-auto
7663no option splice-auto
7664 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7666 yes | yes | yes | yes
7667 Arguments : none
7668
7669 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7670 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007672 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007673 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007674 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7675 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7676 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7677 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7678
7679 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7680 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7681 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7682 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7683 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7684 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7685 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7686 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7687 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7688 keyword.
7689
7690 Example :
7691 option splice-auto
7692
7693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7695
7696 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7697 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7698
7699
7700option splice-request
7701no option splice-request
7702 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7704 yes | yes | yes | yes
7705 Arguments : none
7706
7707 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007708 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007709 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7710 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7711 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7712 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7713
7714 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7715
7716 Example :
7717 option splice-request
7718
7719 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7720 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7721
7722 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7723 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7724
7725
7726option splice-response
7727no option splice-response
7728 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7730 yes | yes | yes | yes
7731 Arguments : none
7732
7733 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007734 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007735 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7736 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7737 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7738 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7739
7740 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7741
7742 Example :
7743 option splice-response
7744
7745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7747
7748 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7749 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7750
7751
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007752option spop-check
7753 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 no | no | no | yes
7756 Arguments : none
7757
7758 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7759 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7760 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7761 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7762
7763 Example :
7764 option spop-check
7765
7766 See also : "option httpchk"
7767
7768
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007769option srvtcpka
7770no option srvtcpka
7771 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 yes | no | yes | yes
7774 Arguments : none
7775
7776 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7777 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007778 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007779 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7780
7781 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7782 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7783 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7784 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7785
7786 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7787 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7788 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7789 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7790 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7791
7792 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7793
7794 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7795 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7796 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7797
7798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7800
7801 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7802
7803
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007804option ssl-hello-chk
7805 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7807 yes | no | yes | yes
7808 Arguments : none
7809
7810 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7811 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7812 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7813 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7814 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7815 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7816 hello message.
7817
7818 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7819 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7820 messages, which is appreciable.
7821
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007822 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7823 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7824 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007825
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007826 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7827
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007828
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007829option tcp-check
7830 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7832 yes | no | yes | yes
7833
7834 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7835 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7836
7837 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7838 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7839 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7840
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007841 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007842 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7843 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7844 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7845 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7846 only.
7847
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007848 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007849 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7850 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7851 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7852 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7853
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007854 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007855 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7856 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007857 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007858 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7859 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7860 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7861 the respective protocols.
7862 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007863 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007864
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007865 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7866 script.
7867
7868 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7869 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7870 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7871 The "comment" is of course optional.
7872
7873
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007874 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007875 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007876 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007877 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007879 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007880 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007881 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007882
7883 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7884 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007885 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007886 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007887 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007888 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007889 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007890 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007891 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7892 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007893 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007894 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7895 tcp-check expect string +OK
7896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007897 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007898 (send many headers before analyzing)
7899 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007900 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007901 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7902 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7903 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7904 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007905 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007906
7907
7908 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7909
7910
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007911option tcp-smart-accept
7912no option tcp-smart-accept
7913 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7915 yes | yes | yes | no
7916 Arguments : none
7917
7918 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7919 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7920 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7921 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7922 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7923 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7924
7925 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7926 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7927 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7928 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7929
7930 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7931 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7932 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007933 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007934
7935 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7936 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7937 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7938
7939 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7940 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7941 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7942
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007943 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7944
7945
7946option tcp-smart-connect
7947no option tcp-smart-connect
7948 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7950 yes | no | yes | yes
7951 Arguments : none
7952
7953 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7954 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7955 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7956 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7957 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7958
7959 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7960 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7961 complex.
7962
7963 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7964 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7965 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7966
7967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7969
7970 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7971
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007973option tcpka
7974 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | yes | yes | yes
7977 Arguments : none
7978
7979 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7980 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007982 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7983
7984 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7985 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7986 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7987 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7988
7989 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7990 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7991 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7992 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7993 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7994
7995 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7996
7997 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7998 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7999 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8000 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8001 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8002 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8003 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8004 backends.
8005
8006 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8007
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008008
8009option tcplog
8010 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008012 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008013 Arguments : none
8014
8015 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8016 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8017 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8018 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8019 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8020 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8021 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8022 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8023
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008024 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008026 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008027
8028
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008029option transparent
8030no option transparent
8031 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008033 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008034 Arguments : none
8035
8036 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8037 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8038 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8039 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8040 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8041 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8042 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8043 appropriate server.
8044
8045 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8046 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8047
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008048 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008049 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008051
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008052external-check command <command>
8053 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 yes | no | yes | yes
8056
8057 Arguments :
8058 <command> is the external command to run
8059
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008060 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8061
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008062 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008063
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008064 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8065 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8066 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8067 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8068 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8069 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008070
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008071 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8072
8073 Environment variables :
8074 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8075 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8076
8077 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8078
8079 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8080
8081 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8082 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8083 for a UNIX socket).
8084
8085 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8086
8087 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8088
8089 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8090
8091 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8092
8093 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8094
8095 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8096 socket).
8097
8098 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8099 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8100
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008101 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8102
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008103 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8104 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8105 failed.
8106
8107 Example :
8108 external-check command /bin/true
8109
8110 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8111
8112
8113external-check path <path>
8114 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8116 yes | no | yes | yes
8117
8118 Arguments :
8119 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8120
8121 The default path is "".
8122
8123 Example :
8124 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8125
8126 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8127 "external-check command"
8128
8129
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008130persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008131persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008132 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8134 yes | no | yes | yes
8135 Arguments :
8136 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008137 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8138 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008139
8140 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8141 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008142 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008143 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8144 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8145 forwarded to this server.
8146
8147 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8148 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8149 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008150 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008151 a single "listen" section.
8152
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008153 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8154 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8155 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8156
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008157 Example :
8158 listen tse-farm
8159 bind :3389
8160 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8161 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8162 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8163 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8164 persist rdp-cookie
8165 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008166 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008167 balance rdp-cookie
8168 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8169 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8170
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008171 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8172 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008173
8174
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008175rate-limit sessions <rate>
8176 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | yes | yes | no
8179 Arguments :
8180 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8181 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8182
8183 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8184 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8185 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8186 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8187 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8188 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8189
8190 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8191 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8192 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8193 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8194
8195 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8196 listen smtp
8197 mode tcp
8198 bind :25
8199 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008200 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008201
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008202 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8203 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8204 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008205
8206 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8207
8208
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008209redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8210redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8211redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008212 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8214 no | yes | yes | yes
8215
8216 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008217 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008218
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008219 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008220 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008221 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8222 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8223 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008224
8225 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8226 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8227 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8228 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8229 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008230 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8231 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8232 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8233 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008234
8235 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8236 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8237 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8238 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8239 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8240 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008241 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008242 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008243 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8244 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8245 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008246
8247 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008248 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8249 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8250 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008251 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008252 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8253 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8254 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8255 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008256
8257 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008259
8260 - "drop-query"
8261 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8262 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8263 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8264 with a location-type redirect.
8265
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008266 - "append-slash"
8267 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8268 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8269 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8270 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8271
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008272 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8273 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8274 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8275 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8276 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8277 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8278 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8279
8280 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8281 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8282 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8283 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8284 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8285 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8286 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008287
8288 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8289 acl clear dst_port 80
8290 acl secure dst_port 8080
8291 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008292 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008293 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008294 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8295
8296 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008297 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8298 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8299 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008300 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008301
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008302 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8303 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8304 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8305
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008306 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008307 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008308
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008309 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008310 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8311 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8312 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008314 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008315
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008316
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008317retries <value>
8318 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 yes | no | yes | yes
8321 Arguments :
8322 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8323 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8324 default value is 3.
8325
8326 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8327 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8328 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8329
8330 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008331 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8332 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008333
8334 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8335 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8336
8337 See also : "option redispatch"
8338
8339
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008340retry-on [list of keywords]
8341 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | no | yes | yes
8344 Arguments :
8345 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8346 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8347 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8348 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8349
8350 none never retry
8351
8352 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8353 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8354
8355 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8356 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8357 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8358 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8359 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8360 processing the request.
8361
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008362 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8363 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8364 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8365 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8366 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8367 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8368 overflow attack for example).
8369
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008370 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8371 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8372 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8373 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8374 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8375 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8376 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8377 amplify denial of service attacks.
8378
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008379 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8380 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8381 considered to be safe to retry.
8382
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008383 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8384 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8385 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8386 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8387
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008388 all-retryable-errors
8389 retry request for any error that are considered
8390 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8391 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8392 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8393
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008394 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8395 not cumulative.
8396
8397 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8398 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8399 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8400 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8401
8402 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8403 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8404 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8405 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8406 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8407 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8408 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8409 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8410 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8411 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8412 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8413 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8414
8415 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8416 should not use this directive.
8417
8418 The default is "conn-failure".
8419
8420 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8421
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008422server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008423 Declare a server in a backend
8424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8425 no | no | yes | yes
8426 Arguments :
8427 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008428 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008429 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008430
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008431 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8432 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8433 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8434 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008435 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8436 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8437 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8438 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8439 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008440 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8441 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8442 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8443 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8444 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8445 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8446 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008447 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008448 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8449 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8450 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8451 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8452 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8453 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008454 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8455 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008456 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8457 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008458
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008459 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008460 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8461 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8462 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8463 adding this value to the client's port.
8464
8465 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8466 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008467 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008468
8469 Examples :
8470 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8471 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008472 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008473 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8474 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8475 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008476
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008477 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8478 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8479 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8480 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8481 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8482
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008483 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8484 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008485
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008486server-state-file-name [<file>]
8487 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8488 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8489 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8490 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8491 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8492 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8493
8494 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8495 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8496
8497 global
8498 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8499
8500 backend bk
8501 load-server-state-from-file
8502
8503 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8504 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008505
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008506server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8507 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8508 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8510 no | no | yes | yes
8511
8512 Arguments:
8513 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8514
8515 <num | range>
8516 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8517 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8518 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8519 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8520
8521 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8522
8523 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8524
8525 <params*>
8526 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8527 keyword.
8528
8529 Examples:
8530 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8531 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8532 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8533
8534 # or
8535 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8536
8537 # would be equivalent to:
8538 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8539 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8540 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8541
8542
8543
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008544source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008545source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008546source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008547 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8549 yes | no | yes | yes
8550 Arguments :
8551 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8552 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008553
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008555 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8556 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8557 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8558 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8559 supported prefixes are :
8560 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8561 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8562 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008563 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008564 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8565 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008566
8567 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8568 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008569 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8570 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8571 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008572
8573 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8574 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8575 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8576 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8577 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8578 <addr>.
8579
8580 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8581 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8582 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8583 port.
8584
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008585 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8586 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8587 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8588 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008589 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008590 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8591 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8592 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8593 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8594 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8595 HTTP header.
8596
8597 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8598 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008599 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008600 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8601 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8602 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8603 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8604 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8605 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8606 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8607
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008608 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8609 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8610 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8611 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8612 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8613 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8614
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008615 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8616 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8617 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8618 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8619
8620 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8621 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8622 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8623 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8624 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8625 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8626
8627 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8628 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8629 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8630 there are two methods :
8631
8632 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8633 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8634 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8635 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8636 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8637 of the client ranges may be used.
8638
8639 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8640 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8641 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8642 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8643 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8644 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8645 same session.
8646
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008647 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8648 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8649 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008650 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008651
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008652 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8653
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008654 Examples :
8655 backend private
8656 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8657 source 192.168.1.200
8658
8659 backend transparent_ssl1
8660 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8661 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8662
8663 backend transparent_ssl2
8664 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8665 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8666 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8667
8668 backend transparent_ssl3
8669 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8670 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8671 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8672
8673 backend transparent_smtp
8674 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8675 # with Tproxy version 4.
8676 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8677
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008678 backend transparent_http
8679 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8680 # proxy.
8681 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008683 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008684 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8685
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008686
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008687stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8688 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008690 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008691
8692 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8693 matched.
8694
8695 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8696 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8697
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008698 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8699 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008700 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008701
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008702 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8703 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8704 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8705 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008706
8707 Example :
8708 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8709 backend stats_localhost
8710 stats enable
8711 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8712
8713 Example :
8714 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8715 backend stats_auth
8716 stats enable
8717 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8718 stats admin if TRUE
8719
8720 Example :
8721 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8722 userlist stats-auth
8723 group admin users admin
8724 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8725 group readonly users haproxy
8726 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8727
8728 backend stats_auth
8729 stats enable
8730 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8731 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8732 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8733 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8734
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008735 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8736 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8737 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008738
8739
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008740stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8741 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008743 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008744 Arguments :
8745 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8746
8747 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8748
8749 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8750 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8751 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8752 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8753 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8754 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8755
8756 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8757 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8758 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008759 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008760
8761 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8762 report using "stats scope".
8763
8764 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8765 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8766 unobvious parameters.
8767
8768 Example :
8769 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8770 backend public_www
8771 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8772 stats enable
8773 stats hide-version
8774 stats scope .
8775 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008776 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008777 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8778 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8779
8780 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8781 backend private_monitoring
8782 stats enable
8783 stats uri /admin?stats
8784 stats refresh 5s
8785
8786 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8787
8788
8789stats enable
8790 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008792 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008793 Arguments : none
8794
8795 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8796 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8797 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8798 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8799 - stats auth : no authentication
8800 - stats scope : no restriction
8801
8802 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8803 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8804 unobvious parameters.
8805
8806 Example :
8807 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8808 backend public_www
8809 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8810 stats enable
8811 stats hide-version
8812 stats scope .
8813 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008814 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008815 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8816 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8817
8818 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8819 backend private_monitoring
8820 stats enable
8821 stats uri /admin?stats
8822 stats refresh 5s
8823
8824 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8825
8826
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008827stats hide-version
8828 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008830 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008831 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008832
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008833 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8834 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8835 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8836 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8837 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8838 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008840 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8841 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8842 unobvious parameters.
8843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008844 Example :
8845 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8846 backend public_www
8847 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008848 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008849 stats hide-version
8850 stats scope .
8851 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008852 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008853 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8854 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008855
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008856 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8857 backend private_monitoring
8858 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008859 stats uri /admin?stats
8860 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008861
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008862 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008863
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008864
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008865stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8866 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8867 Access control for statistics
8868
8869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8870 no | no | yes | yes
8871
8872 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8873 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8874 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8875 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8876 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8877 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8878
8879 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8880 instance.
8881
8882 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8883 about ACL usage.
8884
8885
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008886stats realm <realm>
8887 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008889 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008890 Arguments :
8891 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8892 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8893 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8894
8895 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8896 using a backslash ('\').
8897
8898 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8899 only related to authentication.
8900
8901 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8902 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8903 unobvious parameters.
8904
8905 Example :
8906 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8907 backend public_www
8908 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8909 stats enable
8910 stats hide-version
8911 stats scope .
8912 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008913 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008914 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8915 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8916
8917 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8918 backend private_monitoring
8919 stats enable
8920 stats uri /admin?stats
8921 stats refresh 5s
8922
8923 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8924
8925
8926stats refresh <delay>
8927 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008929 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008930 Arguments :
8931 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8932 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8933 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8934 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8935 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8936 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8937
8938 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8939 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8940 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8941 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8942
8943 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8944 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8945 unobvious parameters.
8946
8947 Example :
8948 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8949 backend public_www
8950 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8951 stats enable
8952 stats hide-version
8953 stats scope .
8954 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008955 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008956 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8957 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8958
8959 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8960 backend private_monitoring
8961 stats enable
8962 stats uri /admin?stats
8963 stats refresh 5s
8964
8965 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8966
8967
8968stats scope { <name> | "." }
8969 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008971 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008972 Arguments :
8973 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8974 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8975 section in which the statement appears.
8976
8977 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8978 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8979 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8980 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8981 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8982 exists.
8983
8984 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8985 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8986 unobvious parameters.
8987
8988 Example :
8989 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8990 backend public_www
8991 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8992 stats enable
8993 stats hide-version
8994 stats scope .
8995 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008996 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008997 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8998 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8999
9000 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9001 backend private_monitoring
9002 stats enable
9003 stats uri /admin?stats
9004 stats refresh 5s
9005
9006 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9007
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009008
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009009stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009010 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009012 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009013
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009014 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009015 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9016
9017 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9018 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9019
9020 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9021 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009022 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009023
9024 Example :
9025 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9026 backend private_monitoring
9027 stats enable
9028 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9029 stats uri /admin?stats
9030 stats refresh 5s
9031
9032 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9033 global section.
9034
9035
9036stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009037 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9039 yes | yes | yes | yes
9040 Arguments : none
9041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009042 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009043 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9044 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9045 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9046 - IP (socket, server)
9047 - cookie (backend, server)
9048
9049 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9050 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009051 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009052
9053 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9054
9055
9056stats show-node [ <name> ]
9057 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009059 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009060 Arguments:
9061 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9062 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9063
9064 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9065 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009067
9068 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9069 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9070 unobvious parameters.
9071
9072 Example:
9073 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9074 backend private_monitoring
9075 stats enable
9076 stats show-node Europe-1
9077 stats uri /admin?stats
9078 stats refresh 5s
9079
9080 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9081 section.
9082
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009083
9084stats uri <prefix>
9085 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009087 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009088 Arguments :
9089 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9090 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9091 query string.
9092
9093 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9094 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9095 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9096 possible to reach it in the application.
9097
9098 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009099 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009100 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9101 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9102 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9103 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9104
9105 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9106 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9107 an address or a port to statistics only.
9108
9109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9111 unobvious parameters.
9112
9113 Example :
9114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9115 backend public_www
9116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9117 stats enable
9118 stats hide-version
9119 stats scope .
9120 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009121 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9124
9125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9126 backend private_monitoring
9127 stats enable
9128 stats uri /admin?stats
9129 stats refresh 5s
9130
9131 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9132
9133
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009134stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9135 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009137 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009138
9139 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009140 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009141 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009142 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009143 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9144
9145 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9146 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9147 the "stick-table" statement.
9148
9149 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9150 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9151 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9152 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9153 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9154
9155 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9156 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9157 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9158 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9159 transformation rules.
9160
9161 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9162 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9163 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9164 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9165 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9166 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9167 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9168
9169 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9170 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9171 ACL based conditions.
9172
9173 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9174 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9175 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9176 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9177
9178 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9179 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9180 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9181 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9182
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009183 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9184 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009185 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009186
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009187 Example :
9188 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9189 # last 30 minutes
9190 backend pop
9191 mode tcp
9192 balance roundrobin
9193 stick store-request src
9194 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9195 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9196 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9197
9198 backend smtp
9199 mode tcp
9200 balance roundrobin
9201 stick match src table pop
9202 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9203 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009205 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009206 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009207
9208
9209stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9210 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9212 no | no | yes | yes
9213
9214 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9215 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9216 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9217 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9218
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009219 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9220 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009221 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009222
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009223 Examples :
9224 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009225 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009226
9227 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9228 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9229 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9230
9231
9232 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9233 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9234 backend http
9235 mode http
9236 balance roundrobin
9237 stick on src table https
9238 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9239 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9240 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9241
9242 backend https
9243 mode tcp
9244 balance roundrobin
9245 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9246 stick on src
9247 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9248 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9249
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009250 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009251
9252
9253stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9254 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9256 no | no | yes | yes
9257
9258 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009259 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009260 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009261 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009262 server is selected.
9263
9264 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9265 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9266 the "stick-table" statement.
9267
9268 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9269 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9270 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9271 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9272 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9273 address.
9274
9275 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9276 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9277 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9278 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9279 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9280 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9281 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9282 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9283 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9284 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9285
9286 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9287 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9288 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9289 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9290 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9291 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9292 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9293
9294 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9295 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9296 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9297 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9298
9299 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9300 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9301 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9302 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9303 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9304 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009305 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9306 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9307 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9308 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9309 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9310 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009311
9312 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9313 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9314 the request.
9315
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009316 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9317 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009318 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009319
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009320 Example :
9321 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9322 # last 30 minutes
9323 backend pop
9324 mode tcp
9325 balance roundrobin
9326 stick store-request src
9327 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9328 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9329 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9330
9331 backend smtp
9332 mode tcp
9333 balance roundrobin
9334 stick match src table pop
9335 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9336 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9337
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009338 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009339 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009340
9341
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009342stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009343 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9344 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009345 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009347 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009348
9349 Arguments :
9350 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9351 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9352 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9353 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9354
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009355 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9356 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9357 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9358 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9359
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009360 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9361 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9362 instance.
9363
9364 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9365 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9366 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9367 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9368 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9369 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009370 to 32 characters.
9371
9372 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9373 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9374 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009375 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009376 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9377 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009378
9379 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009380 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9381 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009382 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9383 increase.
9384
9385 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009386 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9387 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9388 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009389
9390 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9391 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9392 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9393 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009394 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009395 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9396 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9397 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9398 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9399 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9400 parameter (see below).
9401
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009402 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9403 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9404 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9405 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9406 soft restart.
9407
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009408 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9409 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009410
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009411 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9412 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9413 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9414 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009415 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009416 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009417 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9418 if not expiration delay is specified.
9419
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009420 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9421 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9422 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9423 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009424 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9425 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9426 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9427 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9428 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9429 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9430 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9431 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9432 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9433 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9434 types and their arguments.
9435
9436 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9437 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9438 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9439 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9440
9441 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9442 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9443 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009444 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009445
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009446 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9447 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9448 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009449 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009450 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009451 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009452
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009453 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9454 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9455 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9456 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9457
9458 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9459 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9460 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9461 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9462 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9463 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9464
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009465 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9466 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9467 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9468 they were received.
9469
9470 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9471 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9472 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9473 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9474 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9475
9476 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9477 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9478 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9479 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9480 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9481
9482 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9483 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9484 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9485
9486 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9487 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9488 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9489 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9490 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9491
9492 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9493 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9494 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9495 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9496 the client side.
9497
9498 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9499 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9500 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9501 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9502 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9503 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9504 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9505
9506 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9507 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9508 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9509 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9510 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9511 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009512 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009513
9514 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9515 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9516 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9517 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9518 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9519 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9520
9521 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009522 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009523 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9524 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9525
9526 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9527 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9528 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9529 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9530 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9531 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9532 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9533 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9534 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9535 recommended for better fairness.
9536
9537 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009538 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009539 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9540 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9541
9542 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9543 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9544 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9545 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9546 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9547 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9548 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9549 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9550 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9551 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009552
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009553 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9554 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009555 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9556 reference it.
9557
9558 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9559 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009560 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9561 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9562 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009563
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009564 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9565 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9566 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9567 something that can be ignored.
9568
9569 Example:
9570 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9571 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9572 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9573 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9574
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009575 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009576 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009577
9578
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009579stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009580 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9582 no | no | yes | yes
9583
9584 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009585 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009586 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009587 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009588 server is selected.
9589
9590 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9591 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9592 the "stick-table" statement.
9593
9594 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9595 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9596 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9597 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9598
9599 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9600 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9601 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9602 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9603 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9604 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009605 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009606 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9607 rules.
9608
9609 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9610 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9611 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9612 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9613 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9614 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9615 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9616
9617 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9618 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9619 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9620 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9621
9622 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9623 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9624 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9625 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9626 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9627 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009628 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9629 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9630 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9631 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9632 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9633 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9634 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9635 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9636 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009637
9638 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9639
9640 Example :
9641 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9642 backend https
9643 mode tcp
9644 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009645 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009646 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009647
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009648 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9649 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9650
9651 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9652 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9653 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9654
9655 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9656 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009657
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009658 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9659 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9660 # at offset 44.
9661
9662 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9663 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9664
9665 # Learn on response if server hello.
9666 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009667
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009668 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9669 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9670
9671 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9672 extraction.
9673
9674
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009675tcp-check connect [params*]
9676 Opens a new connection
9677 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 no | no | yes | yes
9679
9680 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9681 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9682 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9683
9684 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9685 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9686 of the sequence.
9687
9688 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9689 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9690 do.
9691
9692 Parameters :
9693 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9694 use the TCP connection.
9695
9696 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9697 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9698 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9699
9700 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9701
9702 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9703
9704 Examples:
9705 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9706 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9707 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9708 option tcp-check
9709 tcp-check connect
9710 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9711 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9712 tcp-check send \r\n
9713 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9714 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9715 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9716 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9717 tcp-check send \r\n
9718 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9719 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9720
9721 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9722 option tcp-check
9723 tcp-check connect port 110
9724 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9725 tcp-check connect port 143
9726 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9727 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9728
9729 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9730
9731
9732tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009733 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9735 no | no | yes | yes
9736
9737 Arguments :
9738 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9739 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9740 binary.
9741 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9742 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9743 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9744
9745 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9746 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9747 with the usual backslash ('\').
9748 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009749 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009750 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9751 used upper or lower case.
9752
9753
9754 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9755
9756 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9757 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9758 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9759 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9760 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9761 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9762 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9763 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9764
9765 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9766 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9767 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9768 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9769 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9770 expression.
9771
9772 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9773 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9774 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9775 this exact hexadecimal string.
9776 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9777
9778 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9779 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9780 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9781 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9782 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9783 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9784 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9785 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9786 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9787 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9788 the null character.
9789
9790 Examples :
9791 # perform a POP check
9792 option tcp-check
9793 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9794
9795 # perform an IMAP check
9796 option tcp-check
9797 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9798
9799 # look for the redis master server
9800 option tcp-check
9801 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009802 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009803 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9804 tcp-check expect string role:master
9805 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9806 tcp-check expect string +OK
9807
9808
9809 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9810 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9811
9812
9813tcp-check send <data>
9814 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9816 no | no | yes | yes
9817
9818 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9819 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9820
9821 Examples :
9822 # look for the redis master server
9823 option tcp-check
9824 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9825 tcp-check expect string role:master
9826
9827 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9828 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9829
9830
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009831tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9832 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009833 tcp health check
9834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9835 no | no | yes | yes
9836
9837 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9838 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009839 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009840 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9841 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9842 hexadecimal string.
9843 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9844
9845 Examples :
9846 # redis check in binary
9847 option tcp-check
9848 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9849 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9850
9851
9852 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9853 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9854
9855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009856tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9857 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9859 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009861 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9862 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009864 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009865
9866 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9867 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009868 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9869 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9870 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9871 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9872 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9873 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009874
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9876 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9877 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9878 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009879
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009880 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009881 - accept :
9882 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9883 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9884 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009886 - reject :
9887 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9888 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9889 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9890 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9891 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9892 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9893 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9894 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9895 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9896 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9897 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009898 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009899
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009900 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9901 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9902 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9903 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9904 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9905 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9906 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9907 hosts.
9908
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009909 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9910 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9911 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9912 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9913 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9914 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9915 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9916 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9917
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009918 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9919 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9920 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9921 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9922 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9923 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9924 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9925 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9926 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009927 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9928 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009929
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009930 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009931 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009932 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9933 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9934 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009935 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009936 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9937 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9938 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9939 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9940 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9941 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9942 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9943 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009945 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009946 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009948 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009949 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9950 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9951 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009953 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9954 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9955 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9956 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009958 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9959 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9960 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9961 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9962 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009963 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9964 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9965 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9966 layer7 information is extracted.
9967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009968 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9969 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9970 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9971 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9972 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009973
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009974 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9975 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9976 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9977 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9978
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009979 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9980 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9981 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9982 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9983
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009984 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9985 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9986 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9987 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9988 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009989
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009990 - set-src <expr> :
9991 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9992 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9993 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009994 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009996 Arguments:
9997 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9998 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009999
10000 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010001 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10002
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010003 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10004 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010005
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010006 - set-src-port <expr> :
10007 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10008 expression.
10009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010010 Arguments:
10011 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10012 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010013
10014 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010015 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10016
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010017 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10018 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10019 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010020
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010021 - set-dst <expr> :
10022 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10023 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10024 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10025 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10026 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10027
10028 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10029 followed by some converters.
10030
10031 Example:
10032
10033 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10034 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10035
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010036 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10037 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10038
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010039 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10040 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10041 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10042 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10043
10044
10045 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10046 followed by some converters.
10047
10048 Example:
10049
10050 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10051
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010052 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10053 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10054 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10055
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010056 - "silent-drop" :
10057 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010058 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010059 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10060 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10061 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10062 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10063 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010064 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10065 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010066 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10067 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010068 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010069 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10070 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10071 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10072 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010074 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10075 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10076 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010078 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10079 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10080 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010081
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010082 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010083 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010084 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010086 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10087 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10088 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010090 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010091 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10092 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010093
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010094 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10095
10096 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10097
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010098 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10099
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010100 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010101
10102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010103tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10104 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010106 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010107 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010108 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10109 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010111 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010112
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010113 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010114 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10115 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10116 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10117 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010119 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10120 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10121 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10122 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010123 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10124 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10125 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10126 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10127 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10128 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010129 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010130 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010132 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10133 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10134 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10135 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010136
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010137 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010138 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010139 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010140 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10141 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010142 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010143 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010144 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010145 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010146 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010147 - set-dst <expr>
10148 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010149 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010150 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010151 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010152 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010153 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010154
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010155 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10156 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010157 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10158 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010159
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010160 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10161 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10162 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10163 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10164 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10165 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010167 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010168 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10169 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010170
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010171 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010172 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10173 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10174 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10175 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010176 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10177 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10178 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010179
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010180 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010181 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10182 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10183 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010184
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010185 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10186 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10187
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010188 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010189 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10190 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010191
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010192 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10193 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010194 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010195 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10196 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010197 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010198 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010199 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010200 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10201 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010203 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10204 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010205
10206 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10207 followed by some converters.
10208
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010209 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10210 <var-name>.
10211
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010212 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10213 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10214 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10215 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10216 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10217
10218 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10219 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10220 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10221 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10222 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10223 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10224 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10225 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10226 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10227 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10228 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10229
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010230 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10231 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10232 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10233 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10234 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10235
10236 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10237
10238 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10239
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010240 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10241 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10242 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10243 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10244 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10245 evaluated.
10246
10247 Example:
10248 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10249
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010250 Example:
10251
10252 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010253 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010254
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010255 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010256 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10257 # and reject everything else.
10258 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10259 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010260 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010261 tcp-request content reject
10262
10263 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010264 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10265 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10266 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010267 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010268
10269 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10270 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10271 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010272 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010273 tcp-request content reject
10274
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010275 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010276 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010277 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010278 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010279 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10280 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010281
10282 Example:
10283 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10284 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010285 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010287 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010288 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010289
10290 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010291 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 # protecting all our sites
10293 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010294 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10295 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010296 ...
10297 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10298
10299 backend http_dynamic
10300 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010301 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010302 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010303 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010304 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010305 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010306 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010308 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010309
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010310 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10311 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010312
10313
10314tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10315 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010317 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010318 Arguments :
10319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10321 as explained at the top of this document.
10322
10323 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10324 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10325 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10326 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10327 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10328
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010329 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10330 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10331 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10332 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10333
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010334 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10335 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010336 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010337 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010338 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10339 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10340 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10341 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010342
10343 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10344 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10345 it pass through unaffected.
10346
10347 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10348 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10349 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010350 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010351 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10352 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010353 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10354 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10355 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010356
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010357 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010358 "timeout client".
10359
10360
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010361tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10362 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10364 no | no | yes | yes
10365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010366 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10367 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010368
10369 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010371 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010372 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10373 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010374 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10375 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010376
10377 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10378
10379 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10380 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10381 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10382 inserted.
10383
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010384 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010385 - accept :
10386 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10387 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10388 the rules evaluation.
10389
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010390 - close :
10391 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10392 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10393 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10394 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10395 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10396 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010397 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010398 protocols.
10399
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010400 - reject :
10401 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10402 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010403 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010404
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010405 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10406 Sets a variable.
10407
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010408 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10409 Unsets a variable.
10410
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010411 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10412 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10413 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10414 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10415
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010416 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10417 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10418 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10419 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10420
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010421 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10422 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10423 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10424 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10425 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010426
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010427 - "silent-drop" :
10428 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010429 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010430 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10431 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10432 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10433 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10434 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010435 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10436 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010437 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10438 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010439 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010440 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10441 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10442 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10443 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10444
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010445 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10446 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10447
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010448 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10449 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10450 for changing the default action to a reject.
10451
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010452 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10453 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10454 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10455 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010456 period.
10457
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010458 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10459 declared inline.
10460
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010461 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10462 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010463 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010464 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10465 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010466 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010467 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010468 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010469 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10470 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010471 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010472 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10473 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010474
10475 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10476 followed by some converters.
10477
10478 Example:
10479
10480 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10481
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010482 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10483 <var-name>.
10484
10485 Example:
10486
10487 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10488
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010489 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10490 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10491 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10492 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10493 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10494
10495 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10496
10497 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10498
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010499 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10500
10501 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10502
10503
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010504tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10505 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10507 no | yes | yes | no
10508 Arguments :
10509 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10510 below.
10511
10512 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10513
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010514 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010515 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10516 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10517 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10518 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10519 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10520 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10521 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010522 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010523 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10524 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10525 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10526 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10527 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10528 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10529 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10530 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10531 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10532 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10533 instead.
10534
10535 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10536 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10537 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10538 rules which may be inserted.
10539
10540 Several types of actions are supported :
10541 - accept : the request is accepted
10542 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10543 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10544 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010545 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010546 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010547 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010548 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010549 - silent-drop
10550
10551 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10552 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10553 sections for a complete description.
10554
10555 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10556 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10557 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10558
10559 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10560 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10561 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10562 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10563 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10564
10565 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10566 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10567
10568 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10569 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10570 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10571
10572 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10573 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10574 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10575
10576 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10577 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10578 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10579
10580 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10581 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10582 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10583
10584 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10585
10586 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10587
10588
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010589tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10590 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10592 no | no | yes | yes
10593 Arguments :
10594 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10596 as explained at the top of this document.
10597
10598 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10599
10600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010601timeout check <timeout>
10602 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10603 established.
10604
10605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10606 yes | no | yes | yes
10607 Arguments:
10608 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10609 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10610 as explained at the top of this document.
10611
10612 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10613 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010614 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010615 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010616 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10617 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10618 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010619
10620 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10621 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10622
10623 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10624 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010625 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010626
10627 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10628 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10629 forget about it.
10630
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010631 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10632 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010633
10634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010635timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010636 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10638 yes | yes | yes | no
10639 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010640 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10642 as explained at the top of this document.
10643
10644 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10645 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10646 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010647 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10648 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10649 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10650 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010651 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10652 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10653 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010654 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010655 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010656 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10657 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010658 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10659 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010660
10661 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10663 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10664 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010665 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010666 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10667
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010668 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010669
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010670 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010672
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010673timeout client-fin <timeout>
10674 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10676 yes | yes | yes | no
10677 Arguments :
10678 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10679 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10680 as explained at the top of this document.
10681
10682 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10683 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10684 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10685 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10686 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10687 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10688 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010689 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10690 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10691 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010692
10693 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10694 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10695 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10696
10697 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10698
10699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010700timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010701 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10703 yes | no | yes | yes
10704 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10707 as explained at the top of this document.
10708
10709 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010710 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010711 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010712 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010713 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10714 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010715
10716 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10717 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10718 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10719 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010720 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010721 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10722
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010723 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010725
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010726timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10727 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10729 yes | yes | yes | yes
10730 Arguments :
10731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10733 as explained at the top of this document.
10734
10735 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10736 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10737 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10738 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10739 once the request has started to present itself.
10740
10741 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10742 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10743 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10744 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10745 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10746
10747 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10748 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10749 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10750 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10751
10752 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10753 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010754 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010755 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10756 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010757 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010758
10759 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10760 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10761 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10762 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10763
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010764 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10765 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010766 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10767
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010768 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10769
10770
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010771timeout http-request <timeout>
10772 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010775 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10778 as explained at the top of this document.
10779
10780 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10781 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10782 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10783 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10784 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10785 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10786 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010787 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10788 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10789 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10790 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010792 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10793 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010794
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010795 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10796 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10797 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10798 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10799 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010800 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010801
10802 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10803 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010804 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010805 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10806 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10807
10808 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010809 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10810 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10811 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010812
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010813 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010814 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010815
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010816
10817timeout queue <timeout>
10818 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10820 yes | no | yes | yes
10821 Arguments :
10822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10824 as explained at the top of this document.
10825
10826 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10827 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10828 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10829 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10830 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10831
10832 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10833 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10834 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10835 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10836
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010837 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010838
10839
10840timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010841 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10843 yes | no | yes | yes
10844 Arguments :
10845 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10846 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10847 as explained at the top of this document.
10848
10849 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10850 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10851 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10852 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10853 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10854 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10855 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10856
10857 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10858 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10859 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10860 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10861 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010862 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010863 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10865 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010866 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10867 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010868
10869 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10870 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10871 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10872 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010873 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010874 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10875
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010876 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010877
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010878
10879timeout server-fin <timeout>
10880 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10882 yes | no | yes | yes
10883 Arguments :
10884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10886 as explained at the top of this document.
10887
10888 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10889 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10890 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10891 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10892 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10893 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10894 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10895 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10896 situations, it should not be needed.
10897
10898 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10899 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10900 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10901
10902 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10903
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010904
10905timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010906 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10908 yes | yes | yes | yes
10909 Arguments :
10910 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10912 as explained at the top of this document.
10913
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010914 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10915 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10916 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010917
10918 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10919 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10920 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10921 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010922 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010923
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010924 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010925
10926
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010927timeout tunnel <timeout>
10928 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10930 yes | no | yes | yes
10931 Arguments :
10932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10934 as explained at the top of this document.
10935
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010936 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010937 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10938 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10939 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010940 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10941 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010942 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10943 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10944 specified.
10945
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010946 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10947 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10948 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10949 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10950 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10951 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10952 state.
10953
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010954 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10955 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10956 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10957 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010958 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010959
10960 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10961 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10962 forget about it.
10963
10964 Example :
10965 defaults http
10966 option http-server-close
10967 timeout connect 5s
10968 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010969 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010970 timeout server 30s
10971 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10972
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010973 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010974
10975
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010976transparent (deprecated)
10977 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010979 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010980 Arguments : none
10981
10982 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10983 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10984 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10985 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10986 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10987 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10988 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10989 appropriate server.
10990
10991 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10992
10993 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10994 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10995
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010996 See also: "option transparent"
10997
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010998unique-id-format <string>
10999 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11001 yes | yes | yes | no
11002 Arguments :
11003 <string> is a log-format string.
11004
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011005 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11006 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11007 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11008 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011009
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011010 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11011 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11012 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11013 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11014 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11015 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11016 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11017 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011018
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011019 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11020 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011021
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011022 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011023
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011024 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011025
11026 will generate:
11027
11028 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11029
11030 See also: "unique-id-header"
11031
11032unique-id-header <name>
11033 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11035 yes | yes | yes | no
11036 Arguments :
11037 <name> is the name of the header.
11038
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011039 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11040 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011041
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011042 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011043
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011044 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011045 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11046
11047 will generate:
11048
11049 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11050
11051 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011052
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011053use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011054 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11056 no | yes | yes | no
11057 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011058 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11059 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011060
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011061 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11062 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011063
11064 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11065 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11066 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011067 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011068 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011069 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11070 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011071
11072 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11073 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11074 assign the backend.
11075
11076 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11077 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11078 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11079 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11080 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11081 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11082
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011083 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011084 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011085 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11086 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11087 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11088
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011089 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11090 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11091 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11092 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11093 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11094 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11095 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11096 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11097 cannot be forced from the request.
11098
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011099 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011100 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11101 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11102
11103 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11104 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011105
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011106use-fcgi-app <name>
11107 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11109 no | no | yes | yes
11110 Arguments :
11111 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11112
11113 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011114
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011115use-server <server> if <condition>
11116use-server <server> unless <condition>
11117 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11119 no | no | yes | yes
11120 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011121 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011122
11123 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11124
11125 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11126 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11127 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11128
11129 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11130 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11131 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11132 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11133 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11134 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11135 matches will assign the server.
11136
11137 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11138 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11139 with the next rules until one matches.
11140
11141 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11142 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11143 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11144 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11145
11146 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11147 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11148 stripped.
11149
11150 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11151 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11152 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11153 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11154
11155 Example :
11156 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11157 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11158 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11159 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11160 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11161 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011162 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011163 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11164 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11165
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011166 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011167
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011168
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100111695. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011170--------------------------
11171
11172The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11173depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11174settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11175written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11176described in this section.
11177
11178
111795.1. Bind options
11180-----------------
11181
11182The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11183as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11184no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11185parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11186while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11187provided immediately after the setting name.
11188
11189The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11190
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011191accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11192 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11193 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11194 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11195 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11196 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11197 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11198 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11199 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11200 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011201 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11202 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11203 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011205accept-proxy
11206 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011207 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11208 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011209 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11210 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11211 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11212 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011213 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011214 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11215 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011216 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11217 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011218
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011219allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011220 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011221 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011222 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011223 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11224 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011225
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011226alpn <protocols>
11227 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11228 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11229 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011230 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011231 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011232 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11233 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11234 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11235 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11236 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11237 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11238 preference, like below :
11239
11240 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011241
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011242backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011243 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011244 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11245
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011246curves <curves>
11247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11248 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11249 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11250 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11251 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11252 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11253
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011254ecdhe <named curve>
11255 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011256 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11257 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011258
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011259ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11261 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11262 client's certificate.
11263
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011264ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11266 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11267 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11268 error is ignored.
11269
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011270ca-sign-file <cafile>
11271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11272 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11273 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11274 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11275 'generate-certificates' for details.
11276
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011277ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11279 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11280 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11281 'generate-certificates' for details.
11282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011283ciphers <ciphers>
11284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11285 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011286 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011287 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011288 information and recommendations see e.g.
11289 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11290 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11291 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11292
11293ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11295 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11296 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11297 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011298 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11299 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011301crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11303 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11304 to verify client's certificate.
11305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11308 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11309 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11310 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11311 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11312 file.
11313
11314 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11315 are loaded.
11316
11317 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011318 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011319 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11320 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11321 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11322 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011323 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11324 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011325 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011326
11327 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11328 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11329 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11330 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011331 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11332 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011333
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011334 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011335
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011336 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011337 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011338 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11339 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011340 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11341 clients).
11342
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011343 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11344 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11345 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11346 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11347 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11348 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11349 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11350 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11351 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11352 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11353 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11354 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11355 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11356
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011357 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11358 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11359 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11360 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11361 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11362
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011363 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11364 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11365 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11366 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011367
11368 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11369 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11370 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11371 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11372 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11373 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11374 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11375 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11376 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11377
11378 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11379
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011380 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011381 a cert bundle.
11382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011383 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011384 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11385 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11386 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11387 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11388 provide multi-cert support.
11389
11390 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11391
11392 Filename | CN | SAN
11393 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11394 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011395 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011396 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11397 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11398
11399 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11400 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11401 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11402 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011403 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11404 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11405 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011406
11407 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11408 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11409
11410 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11411 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11412 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11413
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011414crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011416 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011417 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011418 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011419
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011420crt-list <file>
11421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011422 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11423 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011424
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011425 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11426
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011427 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11428 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011429 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011430 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011431
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011432 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11433 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11434 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11435 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11436 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11437 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11438 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11439 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011440
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011441 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011442 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011443 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11444 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11445 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011446
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011447 crt-list file example:
11448 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011449 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011450 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011451 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011452
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011453defer-accept
11454 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11455 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11456 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011457 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011458 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11459 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11460 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11461 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11462 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11463 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11464 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11465
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011466expose-fd listeners
11467 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11468 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011469 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11470 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011471 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011472
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011473force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011474 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011475 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011476 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011477 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011478
11479force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011480 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011481 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011482 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011483
11484force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011485 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011486 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011487 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011488
11489force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011490 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011491 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011492 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011493
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011494force-tlsv13
11495 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11496 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011497 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011498
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011499generate-certificates
11500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11501 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11502 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11503 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11504 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11505 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11506 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11507 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11508 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11509 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11510 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11511
11512 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11513 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011514 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011515 certificate is used many times.
11516
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011517gid <gid>
11518 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11519 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11520 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11521 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11522 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11523
11524group <group>
11525 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11526 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11527 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11528 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11529 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11530
11531id <id>
11532 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11533 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11534 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11535 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11536
11537interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011538 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11539 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11540 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11541 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11542 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11543 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011544 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11545 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11546 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11547 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11548 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11549 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011550
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011551level <level>
11552 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11553 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11554 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011555 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011556 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11557 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11558 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011559 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011560 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011561 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011562 all counters).
11563
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011564severity-output <format>
11565 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11566 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11567 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11568 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11569 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11570 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11571 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11572 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11573 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11574 rfc5424 convention.
11575
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011576maxconn <maxconn>
11577 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11578 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11579 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11580 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11581 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11582 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11583 eat all memory.
11584
11585mode <mode>
11586 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11587 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11588 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11589 UNIX sockets.
11590
11591mss <maxseg>
11592 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11593 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11594 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11595 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11596 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11597 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11598 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11599 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11600 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11601 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11602 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11603
11604name <name>
11605 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11606 page.
11607
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011608namespace <name>
11609 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11610 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11611 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11612 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011614nice <nice>
11615 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11616 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11617 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11618 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11619 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11620 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11621 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11622 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11623 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11624 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11625 one for an RDP socket.
11626
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011627no-ca-names
11628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11629 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11630
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011631no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011632 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011633 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011634 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011635 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011636 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11637 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011638
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011639no-tls-tickets
11640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11641 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11642 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011643 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11644 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011645
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011646no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011648 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011649 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011650 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011651 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11652 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011653
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011654no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011656 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011657 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011658 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011659 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11660 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011661
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011662no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011663 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011664 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011665 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011666 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011667 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11668 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011669
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011670no-tlsv13
11671 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11672 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11673 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11674 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011675 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11676 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011677
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011678npn <protocols>
11679 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11680 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11681 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011682 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011683 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011684 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11685 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11686 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11687 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11688 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011689
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011690prefer-client-ciphers
11691 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11692 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11693 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011694 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11695 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11696 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011697
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011698process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011699 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011700 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011701 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011702 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11703 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11704 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11705 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011706 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011707 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11708 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11709 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11710 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11711 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011712
11713 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11714
11715 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11716 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11717 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11718 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11719 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11720 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11721 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11722 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011723
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011724proto <name>
11725 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11726 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11727 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11728 in haproxy -vv.
11729 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11730 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011731 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011732 h2" on the bind line.
11733
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011734ssl
11735 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011736 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011737 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11738 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011739 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11740 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011741
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011742ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11743 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11744 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11745 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11746
11747ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11748 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11749 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11750 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11751
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011752strict-sni
11753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11754 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11755 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11756 See the "crt" option for more information.
11757
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011758tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011759 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011760 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11761 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011762 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011763 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11764 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11765 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11766 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11767 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11768 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11769 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11770
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011771tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011772 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011773 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11774 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11775 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11776 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11777 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11778 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11779 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011780 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11781 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11782 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011783
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011784tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11785 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011786 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11787 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11788 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11789 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11790 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11791 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11792 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11793 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11794 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11795 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011796 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11797 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011799transparent
11800 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11801 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11802 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11803 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11804 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11805 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11806 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11807 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11808 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11809 so check for support with your vendor.
11810
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011811v4v6
11812 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11813 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11814 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11815 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011816 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011817
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011818v6only
11819 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11820 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11821 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011822 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11823 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011824
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011825uid <uid>
11826 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11827 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11828 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11829 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11830 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11831
11832user <user>
11833 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11834 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11835 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11836 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11837 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11838
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011839verify [none|optional|required]
11840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11841 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11842 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11843 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11844 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011845 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11846 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11847 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11848 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200118505.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011851------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011853The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11854which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11855arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11856settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11857after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11858Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11859address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011861 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011862 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011863
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011864Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11865keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011867The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011868
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011869addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011870 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011871 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11872 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11873 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11874 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11875 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011876
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011877agent-check
11878 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011879 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011880 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11881 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11882 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011883
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011884 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011885 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011886 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11887 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11888 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011890 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11891 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11892 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11893 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11894 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011895
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011896 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011897 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011898
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011899 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11900 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11901 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011902
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011903 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11904 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11905 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011906
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011907 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11908 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11909 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11910 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11911 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011912 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011913 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011914
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011915 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11916 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011917
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011918 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11919 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11920 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11921 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11922 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11923 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11924 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11925 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11926 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011927
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011928 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11929 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011930 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11931 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11932 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011933 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011934
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011935 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011936 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011937
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011938agent-send <string>
11939 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11940 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11941 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11942 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11943 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11944
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011945agent-inter <delay>
11946 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11947 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11948
11949 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11950 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11951 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11952 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11953 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11954 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11955 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11956 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11957 of backends use the same servers.
11958
11959 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11960
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011961agent-addr <addr>
11962 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11963
11964 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11965 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11966 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11967 hostname, it will be resolved.
11968
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011969agent-port <port>
11970 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11971
11972 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11973
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011974allow-0rtt
11975 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011976 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11977 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011978
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011979alpn <protocols>
11980 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11981 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11982 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011983 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011984 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11985 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11986 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11987 now obsolete NPN extension.
11988 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11989 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11990
11991 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011993backup
11994 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11995 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11996 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11997 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011998 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11999 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012000
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012001ca-file <cafile>
12002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12003 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12004 server's certificate.
12005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012006check
12007 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012008 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12009 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12010 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12011 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12012 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12013 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12014 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012015 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12016 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012017 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12018 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012019
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012020check-send-proxy
12021 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12022 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12023 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12024 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12025 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12026 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12027 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12028
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012029check-alpn <protocols>
12030 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12031 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12032 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12033
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012034check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012035 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012036 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12037 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012038
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012039check-ssl
12040 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12041 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12042 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12043 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012044 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012045 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12046 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012047 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012048 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12049 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012050
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012051check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012052 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012053 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12054 for normal traffic.
12055
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012056ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12058 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12059 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012060 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12061 information and recommendations see e.g.
12062 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12063 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12064 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012065
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012066ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12068 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12069 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12070 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012071 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12072 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12073 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012075cookie <value>
12076 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12077 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12078 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12079 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12080 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12081 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12082 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12083
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012084crl-file <crlfile>
12085 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12086 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12087 to verify server's certificate.
12088
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012089crt <cert>
12090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12091 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12092 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12093 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12094 certificate request.
12095
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012096disabled
12097 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12098 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12099 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12100 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12101 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012102 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012103
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012104enabled
12105 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12106 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12107 default value.
12108 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12109 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012111error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012112 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12113 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12114 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012116 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012118fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012119 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12120 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12121 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12122
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012123force-sslv3
12124 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12125 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012126 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012127 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012128
12129force-tlsv10
12130 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012131 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012132 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012133
12134force-tlsv11
12135 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012136 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012137 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012138
12139force-tlsv12
12140 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012141 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012142 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012143
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012144force-tlsv13
12145 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12146 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012147 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012149id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012150 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12151 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12152 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012153
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012154init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12155 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12156 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012158 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12159 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12160 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12161 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12162 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12163 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12164 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12165 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12166 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012167 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012168 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12169 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12170 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12171 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12172 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12173 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012174 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012175
12176 Example:
12177 defaults
12178 # never fail on address resolution
12179 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012181inter <delay>
12182fastinter <delay>
12183downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012184 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12185 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12186 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12187 between checks depending on the server state :
12188
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012189 Server state | Interval used
12190 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12191 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12192 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12193 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12194 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12195 or yet unchecked. |
12196 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12197 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12198 | "inter" otherwise.
12199 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012201 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12202 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12203 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12204 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012205 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12206 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12207 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12208 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12209 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012211maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012212 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12213 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012214 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12215 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012216 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12217 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12218 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12219 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12220
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012221 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12222 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12223 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12224 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12225 than 50 concurrent requests.
12226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012227maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012228 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12229 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12230 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12231 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12232 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12233 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12234 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12235
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012236max-reuse <count>
12237 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12238 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12239 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12240 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12241 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12242 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12243 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12244 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012246minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012247 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12248 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12249 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12250 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12251 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12252 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012253 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012254 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012255
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012256namespace <name>
12257 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12258 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12259 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12260 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12261
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012262no-agent-check
12263 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12264 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12265 default value.
12266 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12267 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12268
12269no-backup
12270 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12271 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12272 default value.
12273 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12274 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12275
12276no-check
12277 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12278 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12279 default value.
12280 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12281 "default-server" "check" setting.
12282
12283no-check-ssl
12284 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12285 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12286 default value.
12287 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12288 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12289
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012290no-send-proxy
12291 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12292 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12293 default value.
12294 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12295 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12296
12297no-send-proxy-v2
12298 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12299 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12300 default value.
12301 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12302 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12303
12304no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12305 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12306 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12307 default value.
12308 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12309 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12310
12311no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12312 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12313 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12314 default value.
12315 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12316 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12317
12318no-ssl
12319 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12320 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12321 default value.
12322 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12323 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12324
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012325no-ssl-reuse
12326 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12327 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12328 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12329 and for paranoid users.
12330
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012331no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012332 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12333 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012334 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012335
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012336 Supported in default-server: No
12337
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012338no-tls-tickets
12339 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12340 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12341 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012342 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12343 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012344 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012345
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012346no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012347 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012348 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12349 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012350 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12351 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012352 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012353
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012354 Supported in default-server: No
12355
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012356no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012357 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012358 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12359 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012360 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12361 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012362 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012363
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012364 Supported in default-server: No
12365
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012366no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012367 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012368 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12369 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012370 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12371 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012372 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012373
12374 Supported in default-server: No
12375
12376no-tlsv13
12377 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12378 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12379 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12380 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12381 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012382 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012383
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012384 Supported in default-server: No
12385
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012386no-verifyhost
12387 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12388 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12389 default value.
12390 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12391 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012392
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012393no-tfo
12394 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12395 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12396 default value.
12397 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12398 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12399
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012400non-stick
12401 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12402 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12403 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12404
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012405npn <protocols>
12406 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12407 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12408 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012409 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012410 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12411 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12412 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012414observe <mode>
12415 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12416 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12417 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12418 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12419 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12420 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012421 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012422
12423 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012425on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012426 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12427 Currently, four modes are available:
12428 - fastinter: force fastinter
12429 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12430 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12431 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12432 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12433
12434 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12435
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012436on-marked-down <action>
12437 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12438 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012439 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12440 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12441 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12442 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12443 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12444 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12445 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12446 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012447
12448 Actions are disabled by default
12449
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012450on-marked-up <action>
12451 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12452 Currently one action is available:
12453 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12454 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12455 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12456 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012457 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12458 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012459 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12460 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12461
12462 Actions are disabled by default
12463
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012464pool-max-conn <max>
12465 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12466 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12467 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12468 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12469 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12470 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12471
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012472pool-purge-delay <delay>
12473 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012474 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012475 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012477port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012478 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12479 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12480 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12481 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12482 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12483 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12484
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012485proto <name>
12486
12487 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12488 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12489 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12490 reported in haproxy -vv.
12491 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12492 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012494redir <prefix>
12495 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12496 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12497 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12498 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12499 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12500 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12501 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12502 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012503 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012504 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012505 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12506 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12507 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12508 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12509
12510 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012512rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012513 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12514 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12515 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12516
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012517resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12518 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12519 server.
12520
12521 Available options:
12522
12523 * allow-dup-ip
12524 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12525 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12526 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12527 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12528 For such case, simply enable this option.
12529 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12530
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012531 * ignore-weight
12532 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12533 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12534 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12535
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012536 * prevent-dup-ip
12537 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12538 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12539 same fqdn.
12540 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12541
12542 Example:
12543 backend b_myapp
12544 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12545 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12546 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12547
12548 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12549 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12550 it
12551 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12552 different address
12553
12554 Default value: not set
12555
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012556resolve-prefer <family>
12557 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12558 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12559 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12560 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12561
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012562 Default value: ipv6
12563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012564 Example:
12565
12566 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012567
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012568resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012569 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012570 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012571 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012572 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12573 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012574 configured network, another address is selected.
12575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012576 Example:
12577
12578 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012579
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012580resolvers <id>
12581 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12582 hostname.
12583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012584 Example:
12585
12586 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012587
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012588 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012589
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012590send-proxy
12591 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12592 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12593 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12594 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012595 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12596 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12597 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12598 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12599 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12600 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12601 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12602 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12603 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12604 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012605 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12606 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012607
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012608send-proxy-v2
12609 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12610 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12611 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12612 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012613 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12614 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12615 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12616 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012617
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012618proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12619 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12620 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012621 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12622 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012623 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12624 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012625 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012626
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012627send-proxy-v2-ssl
12628 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12629 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12630 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12631 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12632 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12633 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12634 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012635 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12636 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012637
12638send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12639 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12640 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12641 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12642 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12643 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12644 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12645 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12646 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12648 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012650slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012651 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12652 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12653 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12654 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12655 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12656 parameters :
12657
12658 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12659 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12660
12661 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12662 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12663 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12664 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12665
12666 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12667 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12668 seen as failed.
12669
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012670sni <expression>
12671 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12672 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12673 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12674 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012675 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12676 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012677 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012678 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12679 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012680
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012681source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012682source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012683source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012684 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12685 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12686 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12687 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12688
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012689 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12690 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12691 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12692 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12693 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12694 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12695 server.
12696
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012697 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12698 specifying the source address without port(s).
12699
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012700ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012701 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12702 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12703 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12704 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12705 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12706 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012707 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12708 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012709
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012710ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12711 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12712 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12713 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12714
12715ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12716 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12717 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12718 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12719
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012720ssl-reuse
12721 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12722 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12723 default value.
12724 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12725 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12726
12727stick
12728 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12729 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12730 default value.
12731 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12732 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012733
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012734socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012735 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012736 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12737 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12738
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012739tcp-ut <delay>
12740 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12741 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12742 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012744 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12745 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12746 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12747 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12748 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12749 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12750 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12751 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12752 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12753
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012754tfo
12755 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12756 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12757 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12758 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12759 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012760 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012762track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012763 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12764 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12765 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12766 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012767 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12768
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012769tls-tickets
12770 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12771 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12772 default value.
12773 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12774 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012775
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012776verify [none|required]
12777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012778 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012779 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12780 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012781 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012782 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12783 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12784 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12785 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12786 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12787 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12788 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12789 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012790
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012791verifyhost <hostname>
12792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012793 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12794 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12795 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12796 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12797 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12798 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12799 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12800 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012802weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012803 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12804 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12805 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012806 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12807 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12808 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12809 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12810 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12811 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012812
12813
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128145.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12815-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012816
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012817HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12818using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12819configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012820This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12821can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12822workload.
12823This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12824resolution at run time.
12825Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12826carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12827
12828
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128295.3.1. Global overview
12830----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012831
12832As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12833different steps of the process life:
12834
12835 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12836 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12837 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12838
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012839 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12840 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012841
12842A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12843 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12844 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12845 resolution to know this new IP.
12846
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012847When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012848HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012849SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12850from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12851will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12852will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012853
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012854A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012855 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012856 first valid response.
12857
12858 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12859 servers return an error.
12860
12861
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128625.3.2. The resolvers section
12863----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012864
12865This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012866HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12867contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012868
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012869When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12870uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12871is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12872answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12873
12874When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012875used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012876
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012877 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12878 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12879 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012880
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012881 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12882 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012883
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012884 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12885 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12886 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012887
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012888For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12889following scenarios are possible:
12890
12891 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12892 ignored
12893
12894 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12895 applied
12896
12897 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12898 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12899
12900 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12901 retries the query with a new type
12902
12903 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12904 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012905
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012906As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12907a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012908<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012909
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012910
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012911resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012912 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012913
12914A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12915
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012916accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012917 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012918 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012919 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12920 by RFC 6891)
12921
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012922 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12923
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012924nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12925 DNS server description:
12926 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12927 <ip> : IP address of the server
12928 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12929
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012930parse-resolv-conf
12931 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12932 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12933 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12934
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012935hold <status> <period>
12936 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12937 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012938 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012939 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012940 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12941 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12942 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12943
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012944 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012945
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012946resolve_retries <nb>
12947 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12948 giving up.
12949 Default value: 3
12950
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012951 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12952 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12953 type.
12954
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012955timeout <event> <time>
12956 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12957 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12958 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012959 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12960 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012961 Default value: 1s
12962 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012963 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012964 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012965 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12966 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12967
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012968 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012969
12970 resolvers mydns
12971 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12972 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012973 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012974 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012975 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012976 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012977 hold other 30s
12978 hold refused 30s
12979 hold nx 30s
12980 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012981 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012982 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012983
12984
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200129856. Cache
12986---------
12987
12988HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12989(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12990RAM.
12991
12992The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12993this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12994
12995If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12996independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12997when we try to allocate a new one.
12998
12999The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13000
13001It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13002"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13003for more details.
13004
13005When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13006replaced by "<CACHE>".
13007
13008
130096.1. Limitation
13010----------------
13011
13012The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13013
13014- If the response is not a 200
13015- If the response contains a Vary header
13016- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13017- If the response is not cacheable
13018
13019- If the request is not a GET
13020- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13021- If the request contains an Authorization header
13022
13023
130246.2. Setup
13025-----------
13026
13027To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13028the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13029
13030
130316.2.1. Cache section
13032---------------------
13033
13034cache <name>
13035 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13036 size of cache is mandatory.
13037
13038total-max-size <megabytes>
13039 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13040 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13041
13042max-object-size <bytes>
13043 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13044 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13045 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13046
13047max-age <seconds>
13048 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13049 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13050 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13051 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13052 default.
13053
13054
130556.2.2. Proxy section
13056---------------------
13057
13058http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13059 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13060 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13061 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13062 after this one.
13063
13064http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13065 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13066 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13067 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13068 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13069
13070
13071Example:
13072
13073 backend bck1
13074 mode http
13075
13076 http-request cache-use foobar
13077 http-response cache-store foobar
13078 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13079
13080 cache foobar
13081 total-max-size 4
13082 max-age 240
13083
13084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130857. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13086----------------------------------
13087
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013088HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013089client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13090The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13091these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13092but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13093data called patterns.
13094
13095
130967.1. ACL basics
13097---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013098
13099The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13100content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13101from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13102simple :
13103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013105 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13107 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013109The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13110adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013111
13112In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013115
13116This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13117Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13118and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013119an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13120conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13121as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13122are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013123
13124ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13125'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13126which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13127
13128There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13129performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013131The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13132specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13133this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013134methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13135ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013136
13137Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13138 - boolean
13139 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13140 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13141 - string
13142 - data block
13143
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013144Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13145converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13146would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13147The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13148which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13149
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013150Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13151keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13152fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13153which are summarized in the table below :
13154
13155 +---------------------+-----------------+
13156 | Sample or converter | Default |
13157 | output type | matching method |
13158 +---------------------+-----------------+
13159 | boolean | bool |
13160 +---------------------+-----------------+
13161 | integer | int |
13162 +---------------------+-----------------+
13163 | ip | ip |
13164 +---------------------+-----------------+
13165 | string | str |
13166 +---------------------+-----------------+
13167 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13168 +---------------------+-----------------+
13169
13170Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13171matching method, see below.
13172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013173The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13174 - boolean
13175 - integer or integer range
13176 - IP address / network
13177 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13178 - regular expression
13179 - hex block
13180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013181The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13182
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013183 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13184 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013186 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013187 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013188 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013189 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13192read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13193if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13194lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13195will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13196beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13197a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13198lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13199exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13200
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013201The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13202parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13203ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13204a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13205check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13206
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013207The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13208socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13209file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13212loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13213
13214 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13215
13216In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13217the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13218case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13219as well.
13220
13221The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13222sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13223do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13224methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13225is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013226obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13228default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13229that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13230string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13231
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013232The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13233By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13234string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13235resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13236server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013237waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013238flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13239function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13242sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13243be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013244
13245 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13246 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013247 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13248 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13249 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13250 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013251
13252 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13253 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013255
13256 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013258
13259 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013260 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013261
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013262 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013263 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13264
13265 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13266 binary or string samples.
13267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13269 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13272 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13273 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13276 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13279 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13282 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13285 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013286 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13289 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13290 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013291
13292For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13293request, it is possible to do :
13294
13295 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13296
13297In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13298buffer, one would use the following acl :
13299
13300 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13301
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013302On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13303possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13304
13305 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13308criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13309method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13310to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13311criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13312the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013314If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013315the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13316For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13319 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13320 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13321 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013322
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013323
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013324The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13325types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13326combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13327brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13328default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330 +-------------------------------------------------+
13331 | Input sample type |
13332 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013333 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13335 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13336 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013337 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013339 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013341 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013343 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013345 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013347 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013348 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013349 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013351 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013353 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013355 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013357 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13359 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013361
13362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133637.1.1. Matching booleans
13364------------------------
13365
13366In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13367Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13368When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13369that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13370
13371Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13372return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13373"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13374
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133767.1.2. Matching integers
13377------------------------
13378
13379Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13380enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13381to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13382
13383Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13384matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13385lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013386
13387For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13388unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13389representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13390
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013391As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13392two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13393instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13394ranges and operators.
13395
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013396For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013397operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13398Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13399of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013401Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013402
13403 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13404 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13405 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13406 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13407 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013409For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013410
13411 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13412
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013413This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13414
13415 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13416
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134187.1.3. Matching strings
13419-----------------------
13420
13421String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13422different forms :
13423
13424 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013425 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426
13427 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013428 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013429
13430 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13431 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13432
13433 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13434 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13435
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013436 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13438 matches.
13439
13440 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13441 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13442 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013443
13444String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13445exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13446characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13447string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13448to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013449before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013450
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013451Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13452(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13453Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13454
13455Example:
13456 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13457 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13458
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134607.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13461---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013462
13463Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13464they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13465possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13466passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13467the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013468the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13469match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013470
13471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134727.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13473-------------------------------------
13474
13475It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13476not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13477a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13478to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13479digits may be used upper or lower case.
13480
13481Example :
13482 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13483 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13484
13485
134867.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13487---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013488
13489IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13490netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13491within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013492host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013493difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13494at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13495does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13496parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013497
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013498The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13499abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13500
13501 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13502 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13503 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13504 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13505 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13506 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13507 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13508 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13509
13510Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13511192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13512
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013513IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13514Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13515trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13516IPv6 patterns.
13517
13518HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13519following situations :
13520 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13521 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13522 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13523 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13524 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13525 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13526 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13527 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13528 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13529 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531
135327.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13533----------------------------------
13534
13535Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13536combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13537
13538 - AND (implicit)
13539 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13540 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013544 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13547indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013549For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13550"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13551requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13552is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13553
13554 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013555 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13556 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13557 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013558
13559To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13560and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13561
13562 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13563 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13564 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13565 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13566
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013567 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013568 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13569 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13570 use_backend www if host_www
13571
13572It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13573expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13574be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13575the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13576
13577 The following rule :
13578
13579 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013580 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581
13582 Can also be written that way :
13583
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013584 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585
13586It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13587to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13588simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13589sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13590good use is the following :
13591
13592 With named ACLs :
13593
13594 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13595 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13596 monitor fail if site_dead
13597
13598 With anonymous ACLs :
13599
13600 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13601
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013602See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13603keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013604
13605
136067.3. Fetching samples
13607---------------------
13608
13609Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13610against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13611sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13612ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13613of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13614available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13615
13616This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13617Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13618compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13619deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13620
13621The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13622matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13623method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13624indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13625
13626As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13627when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13628mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13629the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13630ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13631
13632Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13633multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13634when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013635incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13636are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13638all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13639
13640Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13641 - name
13642 - name(arg1)
13643 - name(arg1,arg2)
13644
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013645
136467.3.1. Converters
13647-----------------
13648
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013649Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13650of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13651is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13652was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013653has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013654unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13655
13656These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13657sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13658the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013660
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013661A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13662support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13663supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13664(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13665bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013667The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013668
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001366951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13670 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13671 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13672 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13673 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13674 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13675
13676 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013677 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13678 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013679 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13680 frontend http-in
13681 bind *:8081
13682 default_backend servers
13683 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13684 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13685
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013686add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013687 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013688 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013689 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13690 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013691 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013692 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13693 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13694 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13695 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013696 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013697 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013698
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013699aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13700 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13701 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13702 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13703 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13704 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13705 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13706
13707 Example:
13708 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13709 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13710
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013711and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013712 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013713 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013714 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13715 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013716 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013717 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13718 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13719 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13720 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013721 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013722 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013723
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013724b64dec
13725 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13726 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13727
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013728base64
13729 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013730 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013731 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13732
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013733bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013734 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013735 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013736 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013737 presence of a flag).
13738
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013739bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13740 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13741 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013742 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013743
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013744concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13745 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13746 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13747 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13748 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13749 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13750 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13751 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13752 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13753 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13754 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013755 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013756 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013757 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013758
13759 Example:
13760 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13761 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13762 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13763 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13764
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013765cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013766 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13767 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013768
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013769crc32([<avalanche>])
13770 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13771 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13772 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13773 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13774 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13775 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13776 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13777 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13778 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13779 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013780 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13781
13782crc32c([<avalanche>])
13783 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13784 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13785 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13786 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13787 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13788 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13789 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13790 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013791
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013792da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013793 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13794 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13795 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13796 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013797 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013798 configuration language.
13799
13800 Example:
13801 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013802 bind *:8881
13803 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013804 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013805
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013806debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13807 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13808 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13809 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13810 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13811 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13812 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13813 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13814 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13815 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13816 printable sample types.
13817
13818 Example:
13819 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013820
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013821div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013822 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13823 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013824 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013825 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13826 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013827 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013828 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13829 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13830 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13831 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013833 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013834
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013835djb2([<avalanche>])
13836 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13837 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13838 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13839 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13840 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13841 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13842 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013843 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13844 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013845
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013846even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013847 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013848 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13849
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013850field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13851 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13852 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13853 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13854 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13855 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13856 fields.
13857
13858 Example :
13859 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13860 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13861 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13862 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13863 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013864
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013865hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013866 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013867 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013868 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013869 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013870
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013871hex2i
13872 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013873 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013874
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013875http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013876 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13877 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013878 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13879 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13880 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13881 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13882 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13883 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13884 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13885 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013887in_table(<table>)
13888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13890 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013891 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013892 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13893
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013894ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13895 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013896 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013897 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13898 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13899 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13900 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13901 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013902
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013903json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013904 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013905 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013906 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013907 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13908 of errors:
13909 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13910 bytes, ...)
13911 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13912 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13913
13914 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13915 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13916 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13917 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13918 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13919 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013920 - "ascii" : never fails;
13921 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13922 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013923 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013924 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013925 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13926 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13927
13928 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013929 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013930
13931 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013932 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013933 capture request header user-agent len 150
13934 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013935
13936 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13937 GET / HTTP/1.0
13938 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13939
13940 Output log:
13941 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13942
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013943language(<value>[,<default>])
13944 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13945 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13946 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13947 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13948 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13949 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13950 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13951 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13952 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013953 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013954 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13955 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013957 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013959 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13960 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013962 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13963 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13964 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13965 use_backend spanish if es
13966 use_backend french if fr
13967 use_backend english if en
13968 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013969
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013970length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013971 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13972 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13973 type. The result is of type integer.
13974
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013975lower
13976 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13977 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13978 type. The result is of type string.
13979
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013980ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13981 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13982 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13983 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13984 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13985 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13986 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13987
13988 Example :
13989
13990 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013991 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013992 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13993
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013994map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13995map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13996map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13997 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13998 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13999 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14000 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14001 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14002 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14003 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14004 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014005
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014006 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14007 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14008 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014009
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014010 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014011 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014012
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014013 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14014 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14015 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14016 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014017 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14018 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014019 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14020 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14021 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14022 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14023 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14024 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14025 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14026 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014027 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14028 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14029 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014030 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14031 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14032 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14033 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14034 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014035
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014036 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14037 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14038 the corresponding match text.
14039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014040 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14041 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14042 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14043 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14044 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014045
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014046 Example :
14047
14048 # this is a comment and is ignored
14049 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14050 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14051 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14052 | | | `---------- value
14053 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14054 | `---------------------------- key
14055 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14056
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014057mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014058 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14059 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014060 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014061 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014062 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014063 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14064 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14065 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14066 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014068 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014069
14070mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014071 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014072 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14073 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014074 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014075 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014076 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014077 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14078 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14079 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014081 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014082 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014083
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014084nbsrv
14085 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14086 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14087 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14088 map lookup.
14089
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014090neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014091 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14092 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14093 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14094 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014095
14096not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014097 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014098 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014099 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014100 absence of a flag).
14101
14102odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014103 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014104 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14105
14106or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014107 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014108 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014109 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14110 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014111 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014112 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14113 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14114 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14115 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014116 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014117 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014118
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014119protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14120 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14121 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14122 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14123 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14124 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14125 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14126 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14127 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14128 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14129 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14130 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14131
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014132regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014133 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14134 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14135 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14136 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14137 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14138 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14139 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14140 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14141 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14142 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014143 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14144 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14145 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14146 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014147
14148 Example :
14149
14150 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14151 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14152 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14153 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14154
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014155capture-req(<id>)
14156 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14157 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14158
14159 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014160 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14161 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014162
14163capture-res(<id>)
14164 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14165 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14166
14167 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014168 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14169 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014170
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014171sdbm([<avalanche>])
14172 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14173 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14174 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14175 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14176 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14177 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14178 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014179 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14180 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014181
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014182set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014183 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14184 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14185 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014186 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014187 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14188 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014189 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14191 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014192 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014193 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014194
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014195sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014196 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014197 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14198
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014199sha2([<bits>])
14200 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14201 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14202
14203 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14204 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14205
14206 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14207 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14208
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014209srv_queue
14210 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14211 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14212 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14213 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14214 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14215
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014216strcmp(<var>)
14217 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14218 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14219 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14220 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14221 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14222 shorter).
14223
14224 Example :
14225
14226 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14227 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14228 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14229
14230
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014231sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014232 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14233 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014234 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014235 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14236 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014237 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014238 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14239 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014240 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014241 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014243 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014244 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014245
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014246table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14247 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14248 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14249 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14250 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14251 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14252 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14253
14254
14255table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14256 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14257 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14258 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14259 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14260 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14261 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14262
14263table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14264 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14265 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014266 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014267 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14268 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14269
14270table_conn_cur(<table>)
14271 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14272 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14273 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14274 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14275 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14276
14277table_conn_rate(<table>)
14278 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14279 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14280 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14281 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14282 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14283
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014284table_gpt0(<table>)
14285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14288 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14289 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14290
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014291table_gpc0(<table>)
14292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14294 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14295 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14296 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14297
14298table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14301 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14302 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14303 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14304 sample fetch keyword.
14305
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014306table_gpc1(<table>)
14307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14309 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14310 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14311 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14312
14313table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14314 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14315 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14316 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14317 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14318 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14319 sample fetch keyword.
14320
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014321table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14322 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14323 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014324 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014325 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14326 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14327
14328table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14331 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14332 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14333 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14334 keyword.
14335
14336table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14337 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14338 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014339 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014340 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14341 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14342
14343table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14344 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14345 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14346 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14347 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14348 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14349 keyword.
14350
14351table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14352 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14353 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014354 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014355 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14356 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14357 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14358 keyword.
14359
14360table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014363 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014364 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14365 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14366 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14367 keyword.
14368
14369table_server_id(<table>)
14370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14373 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14374 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14375 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14376
14377table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14378 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14379 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014380 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014381 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14382 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14383 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14384 keyword.
14385
14386table_sess_rate(<table>)
14387 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14388 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14389 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14390 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14391 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14392 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14393 keyword.
14394
14395table_trackers(<table>)
14396 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14397 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14398 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14399 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14400 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14401 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14402 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14403 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14404 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14405 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14406
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014407upper
14408 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14409 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14410 type. The result is of type string.
14411
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014412url_dec
14413 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14414 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14415
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014416ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014417 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014418 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14419 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14420 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014421 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14422 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14423 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14424 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014425 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014426 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14427 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014428
14429 Example:
14430 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14431 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14432
14433 message Point {
14434 int32 latitude = 1;
14435 int32 longitude = 2;
14436 }
14437
14438 message PPoint {
14439 Point point = 59;
14440 }
14441
14442 message Rectangle {
14443 // One corner of the rectangle.
14444 PPoint lo = 48;
14445 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14446 PPoint hi = 49;
14447 }
14448
14449 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14450 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14451 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14452
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014453 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14454 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014455 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014456 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14457
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014458 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014459
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014460 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014461
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014462 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014463 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14464 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14465
14466 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14467 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14468 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14469
14470 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14471 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14472 interpret the previous binary sample.
14473
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014474
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014475unset-var(<var name>)
14476 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14477 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14478 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14479 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14480 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14481 response),
14482 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14483 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14484 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14485 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14486
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014487utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14488 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14489 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14490 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14491 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14492 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14493 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14494
14495 Example :
14496
14497 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014498 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014499 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14500
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014501word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14502 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14503 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14504 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014505 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014506 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14507 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14508
14509 Example :
14510 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14511 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14512 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14513 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14514 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014515 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014516
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014517wt6([<avalanche>])
14518 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14519 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14520 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14521 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14522 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14523 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14524 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014525 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14526 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014527
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014528xor(<value>)
14529 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014530 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014531 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014532 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014533 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014534 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14535 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014536 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014537 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14538 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014539 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014540 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014541
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014542xxh32([<seed>])
14543 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14544 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14545 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14546 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14547 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14548 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14549 as cryptographically secure.
14550
14551xxh64([<seed>])
14552 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14553 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14554 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14555 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14556 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14557 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14558 as cryptographically secure.
14559
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014560
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145617.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562--------------------------------------------
14563
14564A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14565not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14566"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14567The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14568
14569always_false : boolean
14570 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14571 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14572
14573always_true : boolean
14574 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14575 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14576
14577avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014578 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14580 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14581 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14582 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14583 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14584 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14585 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14586 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14587 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14588 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14589 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14590 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14591 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014594 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14595 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14596 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14597 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014598 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14599
14600be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14601 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14602 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14603 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14604 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14605 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014606 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14607 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014608
14609 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14610 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14611 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14614 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14615 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14616 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014617 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14619 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014620
14621 Example :
14622 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14623 backend dynamic
14624 mode http
14625 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14626 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014628bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014629 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14630 of the string.
14631
14632bool(<bool>) : bool
14633 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14634 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14637 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014638 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14640 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014641
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014642 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014643 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014644 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14645
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014646 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14647 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014648
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014649 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014650 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014652 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014653 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014655 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014657 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14658 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014659 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014660 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014661
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014662cpu_calls : integer
14663 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14664 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14665 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14666 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14667 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14668 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14669
14670cpu_ns_avg : integer
14671 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14672 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14673 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14674 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14675 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14676 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14677 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14678 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14679 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14680 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14681 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14682
14683cpu_ns_tot : integer
14684 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14685 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14686 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14687 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14688 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14689 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14690 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14691 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14692 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14693 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14694 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14695 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14696 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14697
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014698date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014699 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014700
14701 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14702 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14703 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014704 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14705
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014706 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14707 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14708 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14709 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14710 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14711
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014712 Example :
14713
14714 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14715 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014716
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014717 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14718 # millisecond granularity
14719 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14720
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014721date_us : integer
14722 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14723 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14724 from the same timeval structure.
14725
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014726distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14727 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14728 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14729 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14730 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14731 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14732 list of supported tokens.
14733
14734distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14735 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14736 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14737 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14738 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14739 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14740 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14741 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14742 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14743 supported tokens.
14744
14745 Example :
14746 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14747 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14748 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14749 # send large files to the big farm
14750 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14751
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014752env(<name>) : string
14753 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14754 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14755 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14756 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14757 certain way.
14758
14759 Examples :
14760 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14761 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14762
14763 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14764 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14767 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014768 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14769 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14771 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014772 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14774 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014775
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014776fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14777 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14778 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14779 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14782 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14783 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14784 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14785 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14786 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14787 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14788 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14789 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014790
14791 Example :
14792 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14793 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14794 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14795 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14796 frontend mail
14797 bind :25
14798 mode tcp
14799 maxconn 100
14800 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14801 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14802 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14803 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014804
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014805hostname : string
14806 Returns the system hostname.
14807
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014808int(<integer>) : signed integer
14809 Returns a signed integer.
14810
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014811ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14812 Returns an ipv4.
14813
14814ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14815 Returns an ipv6.
14816
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014817lat_ns_avg : integer
14818 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14819 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14820 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14821 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14822 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14823 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14824 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14825 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14826 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14827 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14828 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14829 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14830 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14831 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14832
14833lat_ns_tot : integer
14834 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14835 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14836 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14837 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14838 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14839 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14840 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14841 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14842 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14843 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14844 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14845 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14846 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14847 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14848 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14849 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14850 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14851 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14852 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14853
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014854meth(<method>) : method
14855 Returns a method.
14856
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014857nbproc : integer
14858 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14859 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14860 and debugging purposes.
14861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14863 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14864 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14865 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014866 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14867 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14868 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014869
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014870prio_class : integer
14871 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14872 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14873 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14874
14875prio_offset : integer
14876 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14877 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14878 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14879 set-priority-offset".
14880
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014881proc : integer
14882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14883 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14884 debugging purposes.
14885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014887 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14888 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14889 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14891 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14892 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14893 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14894 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14895
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014896rand([<range>]) : integer
14897 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14898 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14899 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14900 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14901 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14902
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014903uuid([<version>]) : string
14904 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14905 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14906 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14910 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14911 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14912 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14913 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014914 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14915 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14916
14917srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14918 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14919 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14920 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14921 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14922 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14923 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14924 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14925
14926 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14927 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014928
14929srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14930 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14931 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14932 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14935 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14936 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14937
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014938srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14939 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14940 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14941 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14942 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14943 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14944 fetch methods.
14945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14947 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14948 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014949 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14951 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014952 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953 overloading servers).
14954
14955 Example :
14956 # Redirect to a separate back
14957 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14958 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14959 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14960
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014961stopping : boolean
14962 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14963 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14964 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14965
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014966str(<string>) : string
14967 Returns a string.
14968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14970 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14971 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14972
14973table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14974 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14975 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14976 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14977
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014978thread : integer
14979 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14980 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14981 and debugging purposes.
14982
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014983var(<var-name>) : undefined
14984 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014985 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14986 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014987 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014988 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14989 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014990 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014991 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14992 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014993 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014994 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014995
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149967.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997----------------------------------
14998
14999The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15000closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15001methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15002sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15003TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015004the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15005counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015006"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15007used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15008can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15009Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15010table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15011tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15012currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015014bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015015 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15016 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15017 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019be_id : integer
15020 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15021 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15022
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015023be_name : string
15024 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15025 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027dst : ip
15028 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15029 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15030 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15031 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015032 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15033 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15034 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15035 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15036 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15037 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038
15039dst_conn : integer
15040 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15041 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15042 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15043 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15044 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15045 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15046 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15047 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015048
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015049dst_is_local : boolean
15050 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15051 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15052 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15053 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015054 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015055 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15056 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15057 it only once per connection.
15058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059dst_port : integer
15060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15061 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15062 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15063 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15064 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15065 an HTTP header.
15066
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015067fc_http_major : integer
15068 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15069 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15070 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15071
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015072fc_pp_authority : string
15073 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15074 if any.
15075
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015076fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15077 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15078 header.
15079
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015080fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15081 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15082 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15083 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15084 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15085 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15086 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15087
15088fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15089 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15090 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15091 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15092 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15093 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15094 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15095
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015096fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015097 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15098 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15099 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15100 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15101
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015102fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015103 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15104 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15105 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15106 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15107
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015108fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015109 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15110 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15111 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15112 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15113
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015114fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015115 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15116 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15117 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15118 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15119
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015120fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015121 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15122 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15123 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15124 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15125
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015126fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015127 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15128 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15129 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15130 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15131
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015132fe_defbe : string
15133 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15134 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136fe_id : integer
15137 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015138 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015139 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15140
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015141fe_name : string
15142 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15143 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15144 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15145
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015146sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015147sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15148sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15149sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015150 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15151 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15152 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15153
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015154sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015155sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15156sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15157sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015158 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15159 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15160 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15161
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015162sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015163sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15164sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15165sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015166 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15167 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015168 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15169 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15170 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015171
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015172 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015173 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15174 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015175 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15176 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15177 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015178 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15179 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15180
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015181sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15182sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15183sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15184sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15185 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15186 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15187 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15188 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15189 when a first ACL was verified.
15190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015191sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015192sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15193sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15194sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015195 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015196 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15197
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015198sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015199sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15200sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15201sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015202 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15203 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15204 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15205
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015206sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015207sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15208sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15209sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015210 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15211 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15212 See also src_conn_rate.
15213
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015214sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015215sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15216sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15217sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015218 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015219 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015220
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015221sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15222sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15223sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15224sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15225 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15226 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15227
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015228sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15229sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15230sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15231sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15232 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15233 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15234
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015235sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015236sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15237sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15238sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015239 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15240 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15241 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015242 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15243 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15244 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015245
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015246sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15247sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15248sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15249sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15250 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15251 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15252 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15253 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15254 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15255 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15256
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015257sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015258sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15259sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15260sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015261 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015262 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15263 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15264
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015265sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015266sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15267sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15268sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015269 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15270 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15271 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15272 src_http_err_rate.
15273
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015274sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015275sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15276sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15277sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015278 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015279 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15280 src_http_req_cnt.
15281
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015282sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015283sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15284sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15285sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015286 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15287 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15288 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15289 src_http_req_rate.
15290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015291sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015292sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15293sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15294sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015295 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015296 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15297 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15298 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15299 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015300
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015301 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015302 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15303 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015304 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15305
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015306sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15307sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15308sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15309sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15310 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15311 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15312 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15313 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15314 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15315
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015316sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015317sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15318sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15319sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015320 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15321 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15322 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015323
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015324sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015325sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15326sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15327sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015328 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15329 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15330 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015331
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015332sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015333sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15334sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15335sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015336 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015337 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15338 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15339 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015340 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015341 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015343sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015344sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15345sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15346sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015347 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15348 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15349 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15350 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15351 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015352 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015354sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015355sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15356sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15357sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015358 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15359 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15360 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015362sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015363sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15364sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15365sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015366 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15367 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015368 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015369 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15370 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15372 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15373 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375so_id : integer
15376 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15377 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15378 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015381 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15383 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15384 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015385 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15386 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15387 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015388 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15389 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15390 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15391 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15392 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15393 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15394 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015395
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015396 Example:
15397 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15398 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15401 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15402 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15403 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015404 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15407 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15408 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015409 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015410 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15413 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15414 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15415 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15416 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15417 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15418 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015419
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015420 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015421 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15422 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15423 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15424 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015425 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015426 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15427 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15428
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015429src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15430 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15431 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15432 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15433 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15434 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15435 was verified.
15436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015438 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015440 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015441 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015444 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15446 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015447 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15450 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15451 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15452 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015453 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015456 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015458 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015459 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015460
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015461src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15462 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15463 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15464 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15465 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15466
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015467src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15468 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15469 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15470 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15471 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015474 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015476 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15477 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015478 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15479 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15480 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015481
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015482src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15483 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15484 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15485 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15486 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15487 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15488 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15489 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015492 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015494 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015495 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15499 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15500 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15501 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15502 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015503 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015506 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15508 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015509 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15512 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15513 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15514 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015515 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015516 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15519 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15520 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15521 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015522 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15524 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015525
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015526 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015527 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015528 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015529 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015530
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015531src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15532 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15533 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15534 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15535 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15536 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15537 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15538
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015539src_is_local : boolean
15540 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15541 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15542 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15543 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015544 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015545 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15546 once per connection.
15547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015549 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15550 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15551 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15552 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15553 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015556 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15557 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15558 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15559 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15560 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562src_port : integer
15563 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15564 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15565 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15566 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015569 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015570 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15571 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15572 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015573 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15576 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15577 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15578 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15579 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015580 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15583 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15584 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15585 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15586 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15587 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15588 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15589 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15590 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015591
15592 Example :
15593 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15594 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15595 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15596 listen ssh
15597 bind :22
15598 mode tcp
15599 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015600 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015602 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604srv_id : integer
15605 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15606 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15607 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015608
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015609srv_name : string
15610 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15611 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15612 debugging.
15613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156147.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15618closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15619when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15620usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015621future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015622
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001562351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15624 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15625 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15626 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15627 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15628 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15629
15630 Example :
15631 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15632 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15633 # the request.
15634 frontend http-in
15635 bind *:8081
15636 default_backend servers
15637 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15638 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15639
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015640ssl_bc : boolean
15641 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15642 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15643 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15644
15645ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15646 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15647 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15648
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015649ssl_bc_alpn : string
15650 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15651 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015652 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015653 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15654 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15655 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15656 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15657 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15658 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15659
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015660ssl_bc_cipher : string
15661 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15662 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15663
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015664ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15665 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15666 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15667 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15668
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015669ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15670 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15671 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15672 session or a TLS ticket.
15673
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015674ssl_bc_npn : string
15675 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15676 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015677 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015678 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15679 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15680 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15681 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15682 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15683
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015684ssl_bc_protocol : string
15685 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15686 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15687
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015688ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015689 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015690 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15691 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015692
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015693ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15694 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15695 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15696 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15697
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015698ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15699 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15700 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15701 if session was reused or not.
15702
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015703ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15704 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15705 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15706 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15707 BoringSSL.
15708
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015709ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15710 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15711 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15714 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15715 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15716 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15717 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15718 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15721 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15722 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15723 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15724 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015725
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015726ssl_c_der : binary
15727 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15728 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15729 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731ssl_c_err : integer
15732 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15733 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15734 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15735 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15736 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015737
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015738ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15740 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15741 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15742 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15743 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15744 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15745 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15746 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015747 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15748 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15749 LDAP v3.
15750 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15751 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753ssl_c_key_alg : string
15754 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15755 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15756 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758ssl_c_notafter : string
15759 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15760 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15761 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763ssl_c_notbefore : string
15764 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15765 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15766 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015767
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015768ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15770 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15771 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15772 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15773 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15774 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15775 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15776 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015777 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15778 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15779 LDAP v3.
15780 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15781 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783ssl_c_serial : binary
15784 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15785 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15786 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15789 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15790 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15791 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015792 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15793 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15794
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015795 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015796 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15799 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15800 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15801 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803ssl_c_used : boolean
15804 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15805 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807ssl_c_verify : integer
15808 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15809 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15810 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15811 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813ssl_c_version : integer
15814 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15815 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015816
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015817ssl_f_der : binary
15818 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15819 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15820 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15821
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015822ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15824 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15825 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15826 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015827 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15829 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15830 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015831 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15832 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15833 LDAP v3.
15834 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15835 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837ssl_f_key_alg : string
15838 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15839 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15840 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842ssl_f_notafter : string
15843 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15844 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15845 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847ssl_f_notbefore : string
15848 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15849 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15850 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015851
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015852ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15854 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15855 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15856 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15857 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15858 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15859 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15860 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015861 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15862 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15863 LDAP v3.
15864 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15865 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867ssl_f_serial : binary
15868 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15869 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15870 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015871
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015872ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15873 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15874 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15875 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15878 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15879 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15880 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015882ssl_f_version : integer
15883 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15884 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15885
15886ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015887 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15888 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15889 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891 Example :
15892 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15893 listen http-https
15894 bind :80
15895 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15896 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15897
15898ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15899 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15900 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15901
15902ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015903 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15905 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15906 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15907 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15908 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15909 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15910 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15911 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913ssl_fc_cipher : string
15914 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15915 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015916
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015917ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15918 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15919 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015920 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015921
15922ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15923 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15924 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015925 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015926
15927ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15928 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15929 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15930 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015931 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015932 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015933
15934ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15935 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15936 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015937 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015938
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015939ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15940 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15941 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15942 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015945 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15946 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015947 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15948 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15949 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15950 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015951
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015952ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15953 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15954 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15955 wait until the handshake happened.
15956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15958 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015959 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15960 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015961 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015962 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015963
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015964ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015965 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015966 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15967 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015970 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15972 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15973 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15974 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15975 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15976 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15977 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979ssl_fc_protocol : string
15980 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15981 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015982
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015983ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015984 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015985 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15986 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015987
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015988ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15989 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15990 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15991 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15994 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15995 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15996 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15997 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015998
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015999ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16000 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16001 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16002 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16003 BoringSSL.
16004
16005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006ssl_fc_sni : string
16007 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16008 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16009 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16010 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16011 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16012
16013 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16014 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16015 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016016 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016017 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16021 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16024 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16025 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016026
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160287.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16032sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16033only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16034For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16035be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16036can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16037sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16038for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16039content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016042 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16044 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16047 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016048 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016050
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016051req.hdrs : string
16052 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16053 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16054 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16055 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16056
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016057req.hdrs_bin : binary
16058 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16059 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16060 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16061 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16062 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16063 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16064
16065 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16066
16067 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16068 str: <int:length><bytes>
16069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070req.len : integer
16071req_len : integer (deprecated)
16072 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16073 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16074 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16075 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16076 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16077 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16078 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16079 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16082 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016083 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16084 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16085 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16086 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088 ACL alternatives :
16089 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16092 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16093 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16094 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16095 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097 ACL alternatives :
16098 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102req.proto_http : boolean
16103req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16104 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16105 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16106 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16107 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16108 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16109 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16110 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 Example:
16113 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16114 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16115 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016116 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16119rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16120 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16121 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16122 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16123 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16124 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16125 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16126 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16129 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16130 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16131 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16132 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16133 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135 ACL derivatives :
16136 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138 Example :
16139 listen tse-farm
16140 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16141 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16142 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16143 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16144 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16145 persist rdp-cookie
16146 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16147 # This is only useful makes sense if
16148 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16149 stick-table type string size 204800
16150 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16151 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16152 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16155 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16158rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16159 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16160 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16161 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16162 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164 ACL derivatives :
16165 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016166
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016167req.ssl_alpn : string
16168 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16169 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16170 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16171 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16172 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16173 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016174 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016175
16176 Examples :
16177 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16178 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16179 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016180 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016181 default_backend bk_default
16182
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016183req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16184 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16185 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016186 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16187 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16188 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16189 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16190 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16193req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16194 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16195 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16196 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16197 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16198 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16199 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16200 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202req.ssl_sni : string
16203req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16204 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16205 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16206 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16207 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16208 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16209 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16210 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16211 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16212 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16213 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16214 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16215 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217 ACL derivatives :
16218 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220 Examples :
16221 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16222 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16223 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16224 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16225 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016226
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016227req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16228 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16229 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16230 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16231 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16232 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16233 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16234 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16235 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16236 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238req.ssl_ver : integer
16239req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16240 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16241 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16242 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16243 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16244 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16245 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16246 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016247 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250 ACL derivatives :
16251 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016252
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016253res.len : integer
16254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16255 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16256 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16257 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16258 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16259 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16260 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16261 content inspection.
16262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16264 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016265 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16266 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16267 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16268 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16271 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16272 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16273 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16274 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016277
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016278res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16279rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16280 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16281 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16282 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16283 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16284 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16285 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16286 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016288wait_end : boolean
16289 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16290 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016291 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16293 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016294 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16296 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298 Examples :
16299 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16300 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16301 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16304 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16305 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16306 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16307 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16308 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16309 tcp-request content reject
16310
16311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163127.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313--------------------------------------
16314
16315It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16316This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16317data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16318its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16319HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16320content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16321to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16322more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16323response are indexed.
16324
16325base : string
16326 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16327 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16328 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16329 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16330 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16331 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16332 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16333 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16334
16335 ACL derivatives :
16336 base : exact string match
16337 base_beg : prefix match
16338 base_dir : subdir match
16339 base_dom : domain match
16340 base_end : suffix match
16341 base_len : length match
16342 base_reg : regex match
16343 base_sub : substring match
16344
16345base32 : integer
16346 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16347 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16348 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016349 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16350 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16351 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352
16353base32+src : binary
16354 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16355 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16356 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16357 per-URL counters.
16358
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016359capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16360 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16361 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16362 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16363
16364capture.req.method : string
16365 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16366 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16367 because it's allocated.
16368
16369capture.req.uri : string
16370 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16371 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16372 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16373 allocated.
16374
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016375capture.req.ver : string
16376 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16377 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16378 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16379
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016380capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16381 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16382 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16383 The first entry is an index of 0.
16384 See also: "capture response header"
16385
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016386capture.res.ver : string
16387 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16388 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16389 persistent flag.
16390
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016391req.body : binary
16392 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16393 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16394 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16395 the first chunk is analyzed.
16396
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016397req.body_param([<name>) : string
16398 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16399 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16400 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16401 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16402 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16403 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16404 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16405 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16406 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16407 given.
16408
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016409req.body_len : integer
16410 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16411 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16412 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16413 "option http-buffer-request".
16414
16415req.body_size : integer
16416 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16417 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16418 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16419 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16420 "option http-buffer-request".
16421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016422req.cook([<name>]) : string
16423cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16424 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16425 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16426 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16427 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16428 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16429 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16430 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16431 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16432
16433 ACL derivatives :
16434 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16435 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16436 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16437 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16438 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16439 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16440 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16441 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16444cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16445 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16446 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16449cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16450 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16451 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16452 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16453 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16456 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16457 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16458 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16459 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016460 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16462 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16463 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16464 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16467 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16468 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16469 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16470 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016471 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16474 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16475 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16476 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16477 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16478 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16479 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16480 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16481 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16484 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16485 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16486 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16487 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16490 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16491 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16492 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16493 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16494 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16495 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16496 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16497 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016498 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016500 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502 ACL derivatives :
16503 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16504 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16505 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16506 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16507 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16508 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16509 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16510 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16511
16512req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16513hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16514 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16515 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16516 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16517 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16518 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16519 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16520 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16521 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16522 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16523
16524req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16525hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16526 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16527 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16528 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16529 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16530 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016531 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016532 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16533 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16534
16535req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16536hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16537 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16538 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16539 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16540 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16541 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16542 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16543 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16544
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016545
16546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016547http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16548 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16549 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16550 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16551 basic auth is supported.
16552
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016553http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16554 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16555 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16556 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16557 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016558 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16559 basic auth is supported.
16560
16561 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016562 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16563 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16564 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16565 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016567http_auth_pass : string
16568 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16569 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16570 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16571
16572http_auth_type : string
16573 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16574 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16575 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16576
16577http_auth_user : string
16578 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16579 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16580 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016583 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16584 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16586 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016588method : integer + string
16589 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16590 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16591 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16592 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16593 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16594 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16595 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597 ACL derivatives :
16598 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600 Example :
16601 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16602 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16603 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605path : string
16606 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16607 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16608 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16609 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16610 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016611 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016612 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614 ACL derivatives :
16615 path : exact string match
16616 path_beg : prefix match
16617 path_dir : subdir match
16618 path_dom : domain match
16619 path_end : suffix match
16620 path_len : length match
16621 path_reg : regex match
16622 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016623
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016624query : string
16625 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16626 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16627 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16628 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016629 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016630 which stops before the question mark.
16631
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016632req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16633 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16634 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16635 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16636 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016638req.ver : string
16639req_ver : string (deprecated)
16640 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16641 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16642 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644 ACL derivatives :
16645 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647res.comp : boolean
16648 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16649 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16650 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652res.comp_algo : string
16653 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16654 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16655 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657res.cook([<name>]) : string
16658scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16659 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16660 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16661 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016663 ACL derivatives :
16664 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16667scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16668 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16669 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16670 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16673scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16674 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16675 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16676 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016678res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16679 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16680 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16681 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16682 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16683 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16684 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16685 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16686 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16687 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016689res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16690 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16691 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16692 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16693 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16694 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016696res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16697shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16698 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16699 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16700 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16701 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16702 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16703 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16704 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16705 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016707 ACL derivatives :
16708 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16709 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16710 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16711 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16712 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16713 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16714 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16715 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16716
16717res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16718shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16719 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16720 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16721 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16722 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16723 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16726shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16727 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16728 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16729 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16730 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16731 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16732 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016733
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016734res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16735 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16736 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16737 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16738 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16741shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16742 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16743 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16744 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16745 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16746 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16747 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016749res.ver : string
16750resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16751 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16752 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754 ACL derivatives :
16755 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16758 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16759 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016760 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016761 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016763 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16764 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766status : integer
16767 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16768 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16769 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016770
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016771unique-id : string
16772 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16773 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16774 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16775 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16776 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16777 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016779url : string
16780 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16781 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16782 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16783 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16784 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16785 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16786 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788 ACL derivatives :
16789 url : exact string match
16790 url_beg : prefix match
16791 url_dir : subdir match
16792 url_dom : domain match
16793 url_end : suffix match
16794 url_len : length match
16795 url_reg : regex match
16796 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798url_ip : ip
16799 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16800 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16801 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16802 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16803 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16804 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16805 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807url_port : integer
16808 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16809 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16810 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16811 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016812
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016813urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16814url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16816 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016817 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16818 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16819 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16820 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16822 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016823 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16824 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826 ACL derivatives :
16827 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16828 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16829 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16830 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16831 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16832 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16833 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16834 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016835
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016837 Example :
16838 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16839 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16840 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16841 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016842
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016843urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016844 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16845 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16846 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016847
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016848url32 : integer
16849 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16850 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16851 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16852 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16853 is an unsigned integer.
16854
16855url32+src : binary
16856 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16857 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16858 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16859
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016860
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100168617.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16862---------------------------------------
16863
16864This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16865used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16866purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16867There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16868or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16869any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16870for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16871
16872internal.htx.data : integer
16873 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16874 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16875
16876internal.htx.free : integer
16877 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16878 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16879
16880internal.htx.free_data : integer
16881 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16882 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16883
16884internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16885 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16886 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16887 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16888
16889internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16890 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16891 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16892
16893internal.htx.size : integer
16894 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16895 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16896
16897internal.htx.used : integer
16898 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16899 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16900 direction.
16901
16902internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16903 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16904 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16905 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16906 of the special value :
16907 * head : The oldest inserted block
16908 * tail : The newest inserted block
16909 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16910
16911internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16912 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16913 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16914 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16915 integer or one of the special value :
16916 * head : The oldest inserted block
16917 * tail : The newest inserted block
16918 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16919
16920internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16921 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16922 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16923 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16924 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16925
16926 * head : The oldest inserted block
16927 * tail : The newest inserted block
16928 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16929
16930internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16931 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16932 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16933 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16934 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16935
16936 * head : The oldest inserted block
16937 * tail : The newest inserted block
16938 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16939
16940internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16941 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16942 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16943 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16944 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16945
16946 * head : The oldest inserted block
16947 * tail : The newest inserted block
16948 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16949
16950internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16951 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16952 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16953 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16954 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16955
16956 * head : The oldest inserted block
16957 * tail : The newest inserted block
16958 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16959
16960internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16961 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16962 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16963 it returns false.
16964
16965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169667.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016967---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016969Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16970every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016971order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016973ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16974---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016975FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016976HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016977HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16978HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016979HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16980HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16981HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16982HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16983LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016984METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016985METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016986METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16987METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16988METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16989METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016990METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016991METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016992RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016993REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016994TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016995WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16996---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016997
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169998. Logging
17000----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017001
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017002One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17003provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17004very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17005provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17006state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017007to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017008headers.
17009
17010In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17011about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17012send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17013
17014 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17015 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17016 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17017 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17018 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017019 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017020 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017021
17022The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17023allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17024as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17025while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17026real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17027delay.
17028
17029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170308.1. Log levels
17031---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017033TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017034source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017035HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17036in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17037track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17038syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17039about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017040
17041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170428.2. Log formats
17043----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017044
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017045HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017046and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17047slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17048options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017049
17050 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17051 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17052 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17053 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17054 extents.
17055
17056 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17057 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17058 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17059 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17060 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17061
17062 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17063 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17064 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17065 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17066 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17067
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017068 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17069 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17070 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17071 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17072
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017073 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17074
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017075Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17076specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17077field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17078servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17079always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17080identifier.
17081
17082Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17083 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17084 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17085 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17086 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17087
17088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170898.2.1. Default log format
17090-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017091
17092This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17093as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17094format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17095
17096 Example :
17097 listen www
17098 mode http
17099 log global
17100 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17101
17102 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17103 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17104 (www/HTTP)
17105
17106 Field Format Extract from the example above
17107 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17108 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17109 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17110 4 'to' to
17111 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17112 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17113
17114Detailed fields description :
17115 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17116 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17117 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17118 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17119 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17120 and processed the connection.
17121 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17122
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017123In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17124"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17125connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017127It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17128will eventually disappear.
17129
17130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171318.2.2. TCP log format
17132---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017133
17134The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17135is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17136information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17137counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17138emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17139environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17140the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17141sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017142specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17143not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17144fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17145marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017146
17147 Example :
17148 frontend fnt
17149 mode tcp
17150 option tcplog
17151 log global
17152 default_backend bck
17153
17154 backend bck
17155 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17156
17157 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17158 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17159 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17160
17161 Field Format Extract from the example above
17162 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17163 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17164 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17165 4 frontend_name fnt
17166 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17167 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17168 7 bytes_read* 212
17169 8 termination_state --
17170 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17171 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17172
17173Detailed fields description :
17174 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017175 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17176 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17177 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017178 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017179 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017180 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017181
17182 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017183 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17184 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17185 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186
17187 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17188 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17189 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017190 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17191 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17192 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17193 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017194
17195 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17196 and processed the connection.
17197
17198 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17199 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17200 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17201 applications.
17202
17203 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17204 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17205 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17206 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17207 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17208
17209 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17210 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17211 See "Timers" below for more details.
17212
17213 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17214 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17215 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17216 "Timers" below for more details.
17217
17218 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017219 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017220 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17221 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17222 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17223 details.
17224
17225 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17226 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17227 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17228 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17229 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17230
17231 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17232 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17233 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17234 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17235 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17236 for more details.
17237
17238 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017239 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017240 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17241 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17242 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017243 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244
17245 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17246 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17247 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17248 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17249 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17250 caused by a denial of service attack.
17251
17252 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17253 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17254 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17255 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17256 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17257 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17258 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17259 denial of service attack.
17260
17261 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17262 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17263 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17264 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17265 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17266 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17267 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17268 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17269 be processed than on other servers.
17270
17271 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17272 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17273 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17274 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17275 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17276 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17277 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17278 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17279 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17280 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17281 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17282 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17283 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17284
17285 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17286 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17287 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17288 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17289 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17290 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017291 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017292 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17293
17294 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17295 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17296 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17297 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17298 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17299 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017300 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017301 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17302 occurs.
17303
17304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173058.2.3. HTTP log format
17306----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017307
17308The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17309is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17310the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17311are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17312emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17313generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17314"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17315which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017316frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17317is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318
17319Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17320slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17321with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17322
17323 Example :
17324 frontend http-in
17325 mode http
17326 option httplog
17327 log global
17328 default_backend bck
17329
17330 backend static
17331 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17332
17333 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17334 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17335 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017336 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017337
17338 Field Format Extract from the example above
17339 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17340 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017341 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342 4 frontend_name http-in
17343 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017344 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017345 7 status_code 200
17346 8 bytes_read* 2750
17347 9 captured_request_cookie -
17348 10 captured_response_cookie -
17349 11 termination_state ----
17350 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17351 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17352 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17353 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17354 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017355
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017356Detailed fields description :
17357 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017358 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17359 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17360 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017361 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017362 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017363 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364
17365 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017366 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17367 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17368 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017369
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017370 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17371 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017372
17373 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17374 and processed the connection.
17375
17376 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17377 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17378 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17379
17380 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17381 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17382 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17383 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17384 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17385 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17386
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017387 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17388 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17389 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017390 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017391 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17392 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017393 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17394 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395
17396 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17397 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017398 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017399
17400 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17401 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017402 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17403 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017404
17405 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17406 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17407 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17408 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17409 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017410 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17411 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017412
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017413 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17414 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17415 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17416 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17417 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17418 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17419 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017420 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421
17422 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17423 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17424 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17425
17426 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17427 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017428 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017429 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17430 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17431 overflowing.
17432
17433 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17434 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17435 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17436 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17437 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17438 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17439 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17440 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17441
17442 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17443 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17444 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17445 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17446 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17447 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17448 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17449 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17450
17451 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17452 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17453 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17454 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17455 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17456 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17457 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17458
17459 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017460 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17462 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17463 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017464 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465 system.
17466
17467 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17468 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17469 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17470 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17471 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17472 caused by a denial of service attack.
17473
17474 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17475 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17476 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17477 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17478 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17479 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17480 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17481 denial of service attack.
17482
17483 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17484 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17485 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17486 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17487 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17488 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17489 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17490 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17491 processed than on other servers.
17492
17493 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17494 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17495 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17496 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17497 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17498 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17499 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17500 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17501 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17502 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17503 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17504 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17505 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17506
17507 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17508 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17509 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17510 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17511 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17512 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017513 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017514 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17515
17516 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17517 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17518 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17519 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17520 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17521 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017522 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017523 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17524 occurs.
17525
17526 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17527 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17528 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17529 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17530 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17531 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17532 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17533 cookies" below for more details.
17534
17535 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17536 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17537 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17538 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17539 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17540 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17541 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17542 and cookies" below for more details.
17543
17544 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17545 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17546 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17547 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17548 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17549 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17550 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17551 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17552
17553
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175548.2.4. Custom log format
17555------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017556
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017557The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017558mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017560HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017561Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17562separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17563prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17564
17565Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17566variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017567("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017568
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017569If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017570as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017571less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17572the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17573
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017574Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017575In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017576in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017577
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017578Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17579'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17580https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17581such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17582
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017583Flags are :
17584 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017585 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017586 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17587 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017588
17589 Example:
17590
17591 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17592 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17593
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017594 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017596At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17597
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017598 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17599 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017600
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017601the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017602
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017603 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17604 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17605 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017606
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017607and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17608
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017609 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17610 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017611
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017612Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17613
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017614 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017615 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017616 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17617 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17618 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017619 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17620 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17621 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017622 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017623 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17624 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017625 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017626 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17627 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017628 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017629 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017630 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017631 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017632 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017633 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017634 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017635 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17636 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17637 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17638 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17639 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017640 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017641 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17642 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017643 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017644 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17645 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017646 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17647 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17648 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017649 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017650 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17651 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017652 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017653 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17654 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17655 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017656 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017657 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017658 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17659 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17660 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17661 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017662 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017663 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017664 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017665 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017666 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017667 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017668 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17669 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17670 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017671 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017672 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17673 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017674 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017675 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17676 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017677 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017678 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017679 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017680 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017681
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017682 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017683
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017684
176858.2.5. Error log format
17686-----------------------
17687
17688When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17689protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17690By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17691"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017692will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017693logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17694
17695The format looks like this :
17696
17697 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17698 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17699 Connection error during SSL handshake
17700
17701 Field Format Extract from the example above
17702 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17703 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17704 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17705 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17706 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17707
17708These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17709failures.
17710
17711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177128.3. Advanced logging options
17713-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017714
17715Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17716just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17717options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17718for more information about their usage.
17719
17720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177218.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17722------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017723
17724It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17725haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17726commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17727monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17728ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17729
17730 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17731 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17732 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17733 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17734
17735 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17736 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17737 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017738 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017739 such as other load-balancers.
17740
17741 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17742 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17743 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17744
17745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177468.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17747----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017748
17749The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17750what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17751or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017752"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17754log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17755after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17756is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17757with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17758with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17759
17760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177618.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17762------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017763
17764Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17765for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17766"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17767retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17768raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17769a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17770file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17771you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17772"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17773
17774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177758.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17776--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017777
17778Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17779multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17780them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17781"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17782logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17783error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17784and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17785too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17786useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17787alternative.
17788
17789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177908.4. Timing events
17791------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017792
17793Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17794reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17795the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17796frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017797mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17798addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17799
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017800Timings events in HTTP mode:
17801
17802 first request 2nd request
17803 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17804 t tr t tr ...
17805 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17806 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17807 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17808 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17809 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17810
17811Timings events in TCP mode:
17812
17813 TCP session
17814 |<----------------->|
17815 t t
17816 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17817 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17818 |<------ Tt ------->|
17819
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017820 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017821 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017822 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17823 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17824 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017825 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017826 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17827 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17828 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17829 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017830
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017831 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17832 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17833 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017834 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17835 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17836 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17837 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17838 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17839 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017840
17841 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17842 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17843 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17844 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17845 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17846 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17847 request typed by hand during a test.
17848
17849 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17850 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017851 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017852 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17853 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17854 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17855 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017856
17857 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17858 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17859 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17860 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17861 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17862
17863 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17864 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17865 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17866 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17867 connection never established.
17868
17869 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17870 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17871 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17872 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17873 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17874 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17875 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17876 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17877 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17878 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17879 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17880
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017881 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17882 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17883 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17884 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17885 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17886 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17887
17888 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17889
17890 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17891 "Ta" can never be negative.
17892
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017893 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17894 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017895 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17896 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017897 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017899 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017900
17901 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017902 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17903 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017904
17905These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17906protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17907that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017908due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17909"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17910that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911
17912Most common cases :
17913
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017914 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17915 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17916 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17917 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17918 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17919 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17920 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17921 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17922 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17923 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17924 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017925 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926
17927 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17928 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17929 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17930 of ms on remote networks.
17931
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017932 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17933 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17934 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017935
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017936 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17937 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17938 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17939 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17940 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17941 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17942 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17943 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17944 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017945
17946Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017948 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017950 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017951
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017952 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017953 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17954 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17955
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017956 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017957 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17958 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17959 flags.
17960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017961 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17962 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017963 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17964 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17965 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17966 the client connection was maintained open.
17967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017968 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017969 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017970 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017971 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17972
17973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179748.5. Session state at disconnection
17975-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017976
17977TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17978"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179792-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17980each of which has a special meaning :
17981
17982 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17983 session to terminate :
17984
17985 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17986
17987 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17988 server explicitly refused it.
17989
17990 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17991 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17992 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17993 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017994 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017995
17996 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17997 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017998
17999 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18000 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18001 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18002 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18003 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18004
18005 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18006 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18007 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18008 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18009 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18010
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018011 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18012 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18013
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018014 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18015 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18016 backup connections when going up.
18017
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018018 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18021 send or receive data.
18022
18023 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18024 send or receive data.
18025
18026 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18027 with nothing left in the buffers.
18028
18029 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18030
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018031 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018032 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18033
18034 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18035 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18036 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18037 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18038 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18039
18040 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18041 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18042
18043 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18044 server (HTTP only).
18045
18046 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18047
18048 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18049 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18050 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18051
18052 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18053 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18054 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18055
18056 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18057
18058 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18059 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18060
18061 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18062 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18063 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18064
18065 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18066 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018067 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18068 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018069
18070 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18071 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18072 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18073 another server.
18074
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018075 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018076 server.
18077
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018078 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18079 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18080 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18081 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18082
18083 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18084 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18085 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18086 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18087
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018088 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18089 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18090 "use-server" rule).
18091
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018092 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18093
18094 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18095 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18096
18097 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18098
18099 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18100 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18101 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18102
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018103 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18104 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018105 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018106 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18107 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018109 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18110
18111 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18112 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18113
18114 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18115
18116 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18117
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018118The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18119was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018120helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18121starvation, attacks, etc...
18122
18123The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18124alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18125easier finding and understanding.
18126
18127 Flags Reason
18128
18129 -- Normal termination.
18130
18131 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18132 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18133 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18134 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18135
18136 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18137 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18138 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18139 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18140 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18141 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018143 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18144 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018145 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018146
18147 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18148 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18149 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18150
18151 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18152 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18153 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18154 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18155 the server takes too long to respond.
18156
18157 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18158 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18159 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18160 long a time to respond.
18161
18162 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18163 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18164 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18165 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018166 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18167 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018168
18169 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18170 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18171 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18172 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18173 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018174 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018175 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18176 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18177 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18178 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18179 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18180 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18181 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18182 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018183 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018184 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18185 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18186 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018187
18188 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18189 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018190 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18191 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18192 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18193 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018194
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018195 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18196 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018198 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018199 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18200 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018202 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18203 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18204
18205 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18206 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18207 503 or 504 here.
18208
18209 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18210 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18211 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18212 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18213 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18214
18215 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18216 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018217 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018218 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18219 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18220
18221 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18222 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18223 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18224 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18225 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18226 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18227 between haproxy and the server.
18228
18229 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18230 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18231 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18232 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18233 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18234 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18235 solution is to fix the application.
18236
18237 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18238 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18239 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18240 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18241 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18242 external attacks.
18243
18244 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18245 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018246 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018247 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18248 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18249
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018250 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18251 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18252 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018253 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018254 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018255
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018256 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18257 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18258 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18259 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018260 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18261 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18262 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18263 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18264 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018265
18266 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18267 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18268 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18269 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18270
18271 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18272 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18273 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18274 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18275
18276 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18277 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18278 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18279 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018281The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18282persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18283important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18284re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18285
18286 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18287
18288 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18289 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18290 set on a GET request.
18291
18292 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18293 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018294 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018295 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18296
18297 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18298 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18299 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18300
18301 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18302 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18303 already got a cookie.
18304
18305 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18306 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18307 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18308 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18309 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18310
18311 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18312 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18313 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18314
18315 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18316 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18317 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18318
18319 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18320 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18321
18322 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18323 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18324 then advertised in the response.
18325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183278.6. Non-printable characters
18328-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018329
18330In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18331consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18332converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18333prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18334being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18335escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18336is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18337'}' when logging headers.
18338
18339Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18340issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18341containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18342
18343Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18344the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18345performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18346
18347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183488.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18349---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018350
18351Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18352achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018353section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018354cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18355the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18356the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018357locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018358not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18359user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18360a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18361wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18362
18363 Examples :
18364 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18365 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18366
18367 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18368 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18369
18370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183718.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18372---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018373
18374Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18375proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18376the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18377server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18378
18379Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18380response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018381section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018382
18383It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018384time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18385appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018386are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18387and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18388follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18389request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18390in the logs.
18391
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018392As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18393frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18394an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018396 Example :
18397 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18398 listen proxy-out
18399 mode http
18400 option httplog
18401 option logasap
18402 log global
18403 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18404
18405 # log the name of the virtual server
18406 capture request header Host len 20
18407
18408 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18409 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18410
18411 # log the beginning of the referrer
18412 capture request header Referer len 20
18413
18414 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18415 capture response header Server len 20
18416
18417 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18418 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18419
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018420 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018421 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18422
18423 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18424 capture response header Via len 20
18425
18426 # log the URL location during a redirection
18427 capture response header Location len 20
18428
18429 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18430 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18431 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18432 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18433 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18434
18435 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18436 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18437 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18438 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018439 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018440
18441 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18442 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18443 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18444 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18445 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018446 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018447
18448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184498.9. Examples of logs
18450---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018451
18452These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18453them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18454reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18455
18456 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18457 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18458 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18459
18460 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18461 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18462
18463 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18464 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18465 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18466
18467 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18468 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18469
18470 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18471 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18472 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18473
18474 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018475 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018476 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18477 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18478
18479 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18480 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18481 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18482
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018483 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18484 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18485 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18486 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18487 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18488 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018489
18490 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018491 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018492
18493 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18494 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18495 Nothing was sent to any server.
18496
18497 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18498 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18499
18500 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18501 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018502 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018503 send a 408 return code to the client.
18504
18505 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18506 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18507
18508 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18509 5 seconds ("c----").
18510
18511 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18512 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018513 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018514
18515 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018516 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018517 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18518 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18519 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18520 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18521 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018522
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018523
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185249. Supported filters
18525--------------------
18526
18527Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18528accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18529unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18530
18531See also : "filter"
18532
185339.1. Trace
18534----------
18535
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018536filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018537
18538 Arguments:
18539 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18540 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18541
18542 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18543 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18544 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18545 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18546
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018547 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018548 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18549 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18550 amount of the parsed data.
18551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018552 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018553
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018554This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18555callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18556information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18557filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18558
18559Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18560tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18561a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18562
18563
185649.2. HTTP compression
18565---------------------
18566
18567filter compression
18568
18569The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18570keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018571when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18572fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18573done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18574explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18575filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18576listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18577order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018578
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018579See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18580 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018581
18582
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185839.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18584--------------------------------------------
18585
18586filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18587
18588 Arguments :
18589
18590 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18591 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18592 parsed.
18593
18594 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18595 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18596 part must be placed in its own scope.
18597
18598The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18599external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018600streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018601exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18602also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18603
18604SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18605the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18606
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018607For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018608"doc/SPOE.txt".
18609
18610Important note:
18611 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18612 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18613
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186149.4. Cache
18615----------
18616
18617filter cache <name>
18618
18619 Arguments :
18620
18621 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18622
18623The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18624"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018625cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018626other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18627case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18628is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18629filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018630listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18631order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018632
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018633See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18634 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18635
18636
186379.5. Fcgi-app
18638-------------
18639
18640filter fcg-app <name>
18641
18642 Arguments :
18643
18644 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18645
18646The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18647request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18648reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18649used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18650implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18651used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18652fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18653used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18654order.
18655
18656See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18657 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18658
18659
1866010. FastCGI applications
18661-------------------------
18662
18663HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18664feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18665the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18666FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18667servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18668FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18669backend.
18670
18671HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18672application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18673connection.
18674
1867510.1. Setup
18676-----------
18677
1867810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18679--------------------------
18680
18681fcgi-app <name>
18682 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18683 document root must be defined.
18684
18685acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18686 Declare or complete an access list.
18687
18688 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18689 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18690 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18691 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18692 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18693
18694docroot <path>
18695 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18696 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18697 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18698
18699index <script-name>
18700 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18701 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18702 is an optional setting.
18703
18704 Example :
18705 index index.php
18706
18707log-stderr global
18708log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18709 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18710 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18711
18712 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18713 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18714
18715pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18716 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18717 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18718 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18719
18720 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18721 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18722 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18723 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18724
18725 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18726 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18727
18728path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018729 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018730 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18731 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18732 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18733 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18734 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18735 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18736 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018737
18738 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
18739 the null characters are forbiden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
18740 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18741 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18742 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18743 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018744
18745 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018746 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18747 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018748
18749option get-values
18750no option get-values
18751 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18752
18753 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18754 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18755
18756 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18757 application will accept.
18758
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018759 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18760 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018761
18762 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18763 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18764 option is disabled.
18765
18766 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18767 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18768 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18769 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18770 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18771 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18772
18773option keep-conn
18774no option keep-conn
18775 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18776 sending a response.
18777
18778 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18779 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18780
18781option max-reqs <reqs>
18782 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18783 accept.
18784
18785 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18786 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18787 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18788 to 1.
18789
18790option mpxs-conns
18791no option mpxs-conns
18792 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18793
18794 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18795 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18796
18797set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18798 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18799 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18800 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18801 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18802
18803 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18804 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18805 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18806
18807 Example :
18808 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18809 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18810
18811 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18812
18813
1881410.1.2. Proxy section
18815---------------------
18816
18817use-fcgi-app <name>
18818 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18819
18820 Arguments :
18821 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18822
18823 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18824 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18825 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18826 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18827 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18828
18829 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18830 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18831 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18832 application are evaluated.
18833
18834
1883510.1.3. Example
18836---------------
18837
18838 frontend front-http
18839 mode http
18840 bind *:80
18841 bind *:
18842
18843 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18844 default_backend back-static
18845
18846 backend back-static
18847 mode http
18848 server www A.B.C.D:80
18849
18850 backend back-dynamic
18851 mode http
18852 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18853 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18854
18855 fcgi-app php-fpm
18856 log-stderr global
18857 option keep-conn
18858
18859 docroot /var/www/my-app
18860 index index.php
18861 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18862
18863
1886410.2. Default parameters
18865------------------------
18866
18867A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18868the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18869scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18870applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18871
18872 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18873 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18874 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18875 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18876 | | |
18877 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18878 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18879 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18880 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18881 | | application. |
18882 | | |
18883 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18884 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18885 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18886 | | |
18887 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18888 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18889 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18890 | | the application's configuration. |
18891 | | |
18892 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18893 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18894 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18895 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18896 | | |
18897 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18898 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18899 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18900 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18901 | | be defined. |
18902 | | |
18903 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18904 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18905 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18906 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18907 | | is not set too. |
18908 | | |
18909 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18910 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18911 | | set. |
18912 | | |
18913 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18914 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18915 | | the request. |
18916 | | |
18917 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18918 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18919 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18920 | | |
18921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18922 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18923 | | script to process the request. |
18924 | | |
18925 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18926 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18927 | | |
18928 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18929 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18930 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18931 | | |
18932 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18933 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18934 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18935 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18936 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18937 | | |
18938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18939 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18940 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18941 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18942 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18943 | | side. |
18944 | | |
18945 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18946 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18947 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18948 | | connected to. |
18949 | | |
18950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18951 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18952 | | |
18953 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18954 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18955 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18956 | | |
18957 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18958
18959
1896010.3. Limitations
18961------------------
18962
18963The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18964way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18965during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18966establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18967application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18968or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18969message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18970these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18971and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18972
18973Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18974request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18975requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18976
18977About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18978into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18979fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18980"http-request" ones.
18981
18982Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18983FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18984processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18985must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18986here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018988/*
18989 * Local variables:
18990 * fill-column: 79
18991 * End:
18992 */